blob: 7af647ff73d40e52a5dd82add7c9910fd63e3759 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8747b6d2015-03-11 23:57:23 +01007 2015/03/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020053
544. Proxies
554.1. Proxy keywords matrix
564.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
57
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200585. Bind and Server options
595.1. Bind options
605.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020061
626. HTTP header manipulation
63
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200647. Using ACLs and fetching samples
657.1. ACL basics
667.1.1. Matching booleans
677.1.2. Matching integers
687.1.3. Matching strings
697.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
707.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
717.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
727.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
737.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200747.3.1. Converters
757.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
767.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
777.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
787.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
797.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200807.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081
828. Logging
838.1. Log levels
848.2. Log formats
858.2.1. Default log format
868.2.2. TCP log format
878.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100888.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100898.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200908.3. Advanced logging options
918.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
928.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
938.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
948.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
958.4. Timing events
968.5. Session state at disconnection
978.6. Non-printable characters
988.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
998.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1008.9. Examples of logs
101
1029. Statistics and monitoring
1039.1. CSV format
1049.2. Unix Socket commands
105
106
1071. Quick reminder about HTTP
108----------------------------
109
110When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
111fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
112on almost anything found in the contents.
113
114However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
115formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
116correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
117
118
1191.1. The HTTP transaction model
120-------------------------------
121
122The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100123to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
125connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
126will involve a new connection :
127
128 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
129
130In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
131establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
132by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
133length.
134
135Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
136to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
137however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
138response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
139header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
144power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
145but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200146a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147
148A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
149keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
150second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
151page :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
156latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
157correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
158the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100159server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100161By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
162connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
163leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
164start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
167 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
168 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
169 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
170 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
171 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
172 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174
1751.2. HTTP request
176-----------------
177
178First, let's consider this HTTP request :
179
180 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100181 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
183 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
184 3 User-agent: my small browser
185 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
186 5 Accept: image/png
187
188
1891.2.1. The Request line
190-----------------------
191
192Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
193
194 - a METHOD : GET
195 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
197
198All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
199which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
200followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
201is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
202desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
203the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
204
205The URI itself can have several forms :
206
207 - A "relative URI" :
208
209 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
210
211 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
212 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
213
214 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
215
216 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
217
218 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
219 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
220 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
221 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
222 must accept this form too.
223
224 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
225 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
226 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
229 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
230 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
231 other protocols too.
232
233In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
234mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
235on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
236It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
237specific to the language, framework or application in use.
238
239
2401.2.2. The request headers
241--------------------------
242
243The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
244beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
245an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
246Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
247values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
248encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
249the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
250define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
251
252Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
253their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
254"Connection:" header).
255
256The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
257that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
258is one valid form of empty line.
259
260Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
261headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
262about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
263application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
264
265Important note:
266 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
267 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
268 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
269 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
270
271
2721.3. HTTP response
273------------------
274
275An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
276messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
277
278 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100279 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
281 2 Content-length: 350
282 3 Content-Type: text/html
283
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
285codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
286response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100287continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
288the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
289following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
290sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
291(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
292correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
293such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
294state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
295over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
296if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
297information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
3001.3.1. The Response line
301------------------------
302
303Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
304
305 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
306 - a status code : 200
307 - a reason : OK
308
309The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200310 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
312 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
313 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
314 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
315
316Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
319messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
320or "Authentication Required".
321
322Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
323
324 Code When / reason
325 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
326 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
327 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100329 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
330 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331 400 for an invalid or too large request
332 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
333 accessing the stats page)
334 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
335 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
336 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
337 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
338 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
339 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
340 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
341 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
342 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
343
344The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3454.2).
346
347
3481.3.2. The response headers
349---------------------------
350
351Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
352the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
353details.
354
355
3562. Configuring HAProxy
357----------------------
358
3592.1. Configuration file format
360------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200361
362HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
363
364 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
365 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
366 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
367 "frontend" and "backend".
368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100369The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
370referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200371delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003742.2. Quoting and escaping
375-------------------------
376
377HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
378many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
379with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
380single quotes.
381
382If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
383them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
384escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
385
386Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
387
388 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
389 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
390 \\ to use a backslash
391 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
392 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
393
394Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
395the interpretation of:
396
397 space as a parameter separator
398 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
399 # hash as a comment start
400
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200401Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
402-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
403backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
404
405Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200406quoting.
407
408Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
409nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
410
411Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
412equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
413
414 Example:
415 # those are equivalents:
416 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
417 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
418 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
419 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
420 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
421
422 # those are equivalents:
423 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
424 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
425 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
426 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
427
428
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004292.3. Environment variables
430--------------------------
431
432HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
433interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
434configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
435optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
436shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
437underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
438
439 Example:
440
441 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
442
443 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
444
445 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
446
447
4482.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200449----------------
450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100451Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100452values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
453otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
454numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
455for every keyword. Supported units are :
456
457 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
458 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
459 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
460 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
461 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
462 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
463
464
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004652.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200466-------------
467
468 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
469 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
470 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
471 global
472 daemon
473 maxconn 256
474
475 defaults
476 mode http
477 timeout connect 5000ms
478 timeout client 50000ms
479 timeout server 50000ms
480
481 frontend http-in
482 bind *:80
483 default_backend servers
484
485 backend servers
486 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
487
488
489 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
490 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
491 global
492 daemon
493 maxconn 256
494
495 defaults
496 mode http
497 timeout connect 5000ms
498 timeout client 50000ms
499 timeout server 50000ms
500
501 listen http-in
502 bind *:80
503 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
504
505
506Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
507
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100508 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200509
510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005113. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200512--------------------
513
514Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
515are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
516of them have command-line equivalents.
517
518The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
519
520 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200521 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200522 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200523 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200524 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900525 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - gid
527 - group
528 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100529 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - nbproc
531 - pidfile
532 - uid
533 - ulimit-n
534 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200535 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100536 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200537 - node
538 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100539 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200541 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200542 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200543 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200544 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100545 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100546 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100547 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200548 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200549 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200550 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200551 - noepoll
552 - nokqueue
553 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100554 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300555 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200556 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200557 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200558 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100559 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100560 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200561 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100562 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100563 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100564 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100565 - tune.lua.session-timeout
566 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100567 - tune.maxaccept
568 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200569 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200570 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200571 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100572 - tune.rcvbuf.client
573 - tune.rcvbuf.server
574 - tune.sndbuf.client
575 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100576 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100577 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200578 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100579 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200580 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100581 - tune.zlib.memlevel
582 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100583
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 * Debugging
585 - debug
586 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587
588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005893.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590------------------------------------
591
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200592ca-base <dir>
593 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200594 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
595 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200596
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597chroot <jail dir>
598 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
599 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
600 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
601 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
602 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
603 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100604
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100605cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
606 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
607 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
608 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100609 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
610 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
611 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
612 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
613 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
614 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
615 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
616 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
617 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
618 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100619
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200620crt-base <dir>
621 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
622 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
623 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
624
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625daemon
626 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
627 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
628 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
629
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900630external-check
631 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
632 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
633 See "option external-check".
634
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200635gid <number>
636 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
637 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
638 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100639 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
640 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200641 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100642
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200643group <group name>
644 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
645 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100646
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200647log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
649 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100650 configured with "log global".
651
652 <address> can be one of:
653
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100654 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100655 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
656 port).
657
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100658 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
659 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
660 port).
661
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100662 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
663 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
664 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
665 writeable).
666
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200667 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
668 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100669
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200670 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
671 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
672 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
673 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
674 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
675 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
676 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
677 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
678 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
679 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
680 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
681
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100682 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200683
684 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
685 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
686 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
687
688 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200689 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
690 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
691 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
692 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
693 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
694 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200696 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100698log-send-hostname [<string>]
699 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
700 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
701 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
702 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
703 the logs.
704
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000705log-tag <string>
706 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
707 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
708 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100709 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000710
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100711lua-load <file>
712 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
713 used multiple times.
714
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200715nbproc <number>
716 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
717 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
718 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
719 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
720 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
721
722pidfile <pidfile>
723 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
724 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
725 starting the process. See also "daemon".
726
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100727stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200728 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
729 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
730 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
731 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
732 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
733 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100734 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200735 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
736 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200737
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100738ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
739 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
740 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300741 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100742 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
743 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
744 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
745 "bind" keyword for more information.
746
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100747ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
748 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
749 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
750 keyword to see available options.
751
752 Example:
753 global
754 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
755
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100756ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
757 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
758 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300759 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100760 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
761 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
762 information.
763
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100764ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
765 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
766 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
767 keyword to see available options.
768
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100769ssl-server-verify [none|required]
770 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
771 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
772 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
773
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200774stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
775 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
776 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
777 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
778 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200779
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200780 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
781 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
782 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200783
784stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
785 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
786 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100787 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200788
789stats maxconn <connections>
790 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
791 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
792
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200793uid <number>
794 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
795 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
796 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
797 one. See also "gid" and "user".
798
799ulimit-n <number>
800 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
801 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
802 option.
803
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100804unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
805 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
806
807 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
808 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
809 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
810 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
811 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
812 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
813 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
814 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
815 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
816 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
817
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200818user <user name>
819 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
820 See also "uid" and "group".
821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200822node <name>
823 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
824
825 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
826 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
827 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
828 traffic.
829
830description <text>
831 Add a text that describes the instance.
832
833 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
834 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
835 "<" and ">" characters.
836
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008383.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200839-----------------------
840
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200841max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
842 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
843 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
844 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
845 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
846 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
847 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
848 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
849 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
850
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200851maxconn <number>
852 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
853 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
854 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200855 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
856 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
857 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
858 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100859 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
860 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
861 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
862 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
863 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200864
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200865maxconnrate <number>
866 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
867 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
868 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
869 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
870 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
871 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
872 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
873 fairness.
874
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100875maxcomprate <number>
876 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300877 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100878 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
879 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
880 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
881 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
882 default value.
883
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100884maxcompcpuusage <number>
885 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
886 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
887 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
888 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
889 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
890 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
891 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
892 process down and from introducing high latencies.
893
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100894maxpipes <number>
895 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
896 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
897 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
898 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
899 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
900 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
901
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200902maxsessrate <number>
903 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
904 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
905 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
906 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
907 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
908 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
909 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
910 fairness.
911
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200912maxsslconn <number>
913 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
914 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
915 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
916 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
917 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
918 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
919 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100920 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
921 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
922 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
923 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
924 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
925 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
926 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200927
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200928maxsslrate <number>
929 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
930 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
931 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
932 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
933 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
934 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
935 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
936 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
937 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
938 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
939
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100940maxzlibmem <number>
941 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
942 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
943 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100944 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
945 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
946 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
947
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200948noepoll
949 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
950 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100951 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952
953nokqueue
954 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
955 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
956 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
957
958nopoll
959 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
960 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100961 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100962 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200963
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100964nosplice
965 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
966 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
967 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100968 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100969 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
970 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
971 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
972 "option splice-response".
973
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300974nogetaddrinfo
975 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
976 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
977
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200978spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900979 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
980 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
981 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
982 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
983 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
984 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200985
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +0100986tune.buffers.limit <number>
987 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
988 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
989 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
990 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
991 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
992 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
993 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
994 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
995 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
996 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
997 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
998 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
999 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1000 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1001 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1002
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001003tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1004 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1005 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1006 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1007 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1008
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001009tune.bufsize <number>
1010 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1011 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1012 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1013 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1014 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1015 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1016 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1017 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001018 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1019 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1020 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001021
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001022tune.chksize <number>
1023 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1024 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1025 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1026 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1027 checks whenever possible.
1028
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001029tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1030 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1031 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1032 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1033 this value. The default value is 1.
1034
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001035tune.http.cookielen <number>
1036 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1037 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1038 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1039 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1040 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1041 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1042 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1043 to change this value.
1044
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001045tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1046 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1047 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1048 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1049 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1050 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1051 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1052 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1053 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1054 limit too high.
1055
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001056tune.idletimer <timeout>
1057 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1058 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1059 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1060 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1061 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1062 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1063 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1064 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1065 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1066
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001067tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1068 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1069 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1070 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1071 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1072 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1073 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1074 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1075
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001076tune.lua.maxmem
1077 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1078 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1079 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1080 memory.
1081
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001082tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1083 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1084 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1085 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1086 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1087 4s.
1088
1089tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1090 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1091 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1092 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1093 check servers.
1094
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001095tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001096 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1097 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1098 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1099 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1100 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1101 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1102 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1103 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1104 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1105 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001106
1107tune.maxpollevents <number>
1108 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1109 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1110 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1111 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1112 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1113
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001114tune.maxrewrite <number>
1115 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1116 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1117 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1118 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1119 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1120 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1121 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1122 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1123 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1124 bufsize.
1125
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001126tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1127 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1128 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1129 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1130 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1131 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1132 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1133 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1134 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1135 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1136 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1137 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1138 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1139 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1140 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1141 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1142 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1143 setting this parameter to 0.
1144
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001145tune.pipesize <number>
1146 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1147 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1148 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1149 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1150 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1151 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1152
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001153tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1154tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1155 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1156 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1157 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1158 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1159 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1160 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1161 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1162
1163tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1164tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1165 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1166 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1167 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1168 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1169 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1170 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1171 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1172 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1173 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1174 notifying haproxy again.
1175
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001176tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001177 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1178 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1179 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001180 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001181 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1182 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1183 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1184 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1185 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001186 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1187 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001188
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001189tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1190 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1191 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1192 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1193 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1194 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1195 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1196
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001197tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1198 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001199 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001200 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1201 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1202 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1203 being used for too long.
1204
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001205tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1206 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1207 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1208 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1209 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1210 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1211 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1212 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1213 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1214 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1215 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001216 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1217 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001218
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001219tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1220 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1221 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1222 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1223 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1224 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1225 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1226 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1227 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1228
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001229tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1230 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001231 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001232 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1233 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1234 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1235
1236tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1237 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1238 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1239 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1240 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012423.3. Debugging
1243--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001244
1245debug
1246 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1247 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1248 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1249 system startup.
1250
1251quiet
1252 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1253 line argument "-q".
1254
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001255
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012563.4. Userlists
1257--------------
1258It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1259http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1260it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1261
1262userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001263 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001264 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1265
1266group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001267 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001268 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1269 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1270
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001271user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1272 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001273 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1274 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001275 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1276 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001277 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001278 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001279
1280
1281 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001282 userlist L1
1283 group G1 users tiger,scott
1284 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001285
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001286 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1287 user scott insecure-password elgato
1288 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001289
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001290 userlist L2
1291 group G1
1292 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001293
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001294 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1295 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1296 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001297
1298 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001299
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001300
13013.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001302----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001303It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1304haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1305pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1306identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1307or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1308Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1309known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1310the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1311process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1312during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1313tables.
1314
1315peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001316 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001317 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1318
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001319disabled
1320 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1321 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1322 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1323
1324enable
1325 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1326
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001327peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1328 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1329 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1330 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1331 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1332 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1333 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1334
1335 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1336 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1337
1338 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1339 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1340 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1341 across all peers.
1342
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001343 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1344 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001345
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001346 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001347 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001348 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1349 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1350 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001351
1352 backend mybackend
1353 mode tcp
1354 balance roundrobin
1355 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1356 stick on src
1357
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001358 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1359 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001360
1361
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090013623.6. Mailers
1363------------
1364It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1365If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1366in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1367
1368mailer <mailersect>
1369 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1370 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1371
1372mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1373 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1374
1375 Example:
1376 mailers mymailers
1377 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1378 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1379
1380 backend mybackend
1381 mode tcp
1382 balance roundrobin
1383
1384 email-alert mailers mymailers
1385 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1386 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1387
1388 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1389 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1390
1391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013924. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001393----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001394
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001395Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1396 - defaults <name>
1397 - frontend <name>
1398 - backend <name>
1399 - listen <name>
1400
1401A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1402its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1403section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001404section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001405
1406A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1407connections.
1408
1409A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1410to forward incoming connections.
1411
1412A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1413parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001415All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1416'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1417case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1418
1419Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1420logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1421proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1422However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1423name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1424
1425Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1426and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001427bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001428protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1429modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1430arbitrary criteria.
1431
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001432In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1433a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1434the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1435
1436 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1437 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1438 between responses and new requests.
1439
1440 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1441 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1442 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1443 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1444
1445 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1446 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1447 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1448
1449 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1450 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1451 client-facing connection remains open.
1452
1453 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1454 after the end of the response.
1455
1456The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1457frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1458following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1459weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1460
1461 Backend mode
1462
1463 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1464 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1465 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1466 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1467 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1468 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1469 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1470 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1471 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1472 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1473 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1474
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001475
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014774.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1478--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001480The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1481limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1482they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1483limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001484marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001485option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001486and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1487with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1488specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001489
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001490
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001491 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1492------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1493acl - X X X
1494appsession - - X X
1495backlog X X X -
1496balance X - X X
1497bind - X X -
1498bind-process X X X X
1499block - X X X
1500capture cookie - X X -
1501capture request header - X X -
1502capture response header - X X -
1503clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001504compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001505contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1506cookie X - X X
1507default-server X - X X
1508default_backend X X X -
1509description - X X X
1510disabled X X X X
1511dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001512email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001513email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001514email-alert mailers X X X X
1515email-alert myhostname X X X X
1516email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001517enabled X X X X
1518errorfile X X X X
1519errorloc X X X X
1520errorloc302 X X X X
1521-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1522errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001523force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001524fullconn X - X X
1525grace X X X X
1526hash-type X - X X
1527http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001528http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001529http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001530http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001531http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001532http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001533id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001534ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001535log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001536log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001537log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001538max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001539maxconn X X X -
1540mode X X X X
1541monitor fail - X X -
1542monitor-net X X X -
1543monitor-uri X X X -
1544option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1545option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1546option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1547option allbackups (*) X - X X
1548option checkcache (*) X - X X
1549option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1550option contstats (*) X X X -
1551option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1552option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1553option forceclose (*) X X X X
1554-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1555option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001556option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001557option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001558option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001559option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001560option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001561option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001562option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001563option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1564option httpchk X - X X
1565option httpclose (*) X X X X
1566option httplog X X X X
1567option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001568option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001569option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001570option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001571option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1572option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1573option logasap (*) X X X -
1574option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001575option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001576option nolinger (*) X X X X
1577option originalto X X X X
1578option persist (*) X - X X
1579option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001580option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001581option smtpchk X - X X
1582option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1583option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1584option splice-request (*) X X X X
1585option splice-response (*) X X X X
1586option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1587option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1588-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001589option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001590option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1591option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1592option tcpka X X X X
1593option tcplog X X X X
1594option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001595external-check command X - X X
1596external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001597persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1598rate-limit sessions X X X -
1599redirect - X X X
1600redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1601redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1602reqadd - X X X
1603reqallow - X X X
1604reqdel - X X X
1605reqdeny - X X X
1606reqiallow - X X X
1607reqidel - X X X
1608reqideny - X X X
1609reqipass - X X X
1610reqirep - X X X
1611reqisetbe - X X X
1612reqitarpit - X X X
1613reqpass - X X X
1614reqrep - X X X
1615-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1616reqsetbe - X X X
1617reqtarpit - X X X
1618retries X - X X
1619rspadd - X X X
1620rspdel - X X X
1621rspdeny - X X X
1622rspidel - X X X
1623rspideny - X X X
1624rspirep - X X X
1625rsprep - X X X
1626server - - X X
1627source X - X X
1628srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001629stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001630stats auth X - X X
1631stats enable X - X X
1632stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001633stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001634stats realm X - X X
1635stats refresh X - X X
1636stats scope X - X X
1637stats show-desc X - X X
1638stats show-legends X - X X
1639stats show-node X - X X
1640stats uri X - X X
1641-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1642stick match - - X X
1643stick on - - X X
1644stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001645stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001646stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001647tcp-check connect - - X X
1648tcp-check expect - - X X
1649tcp-check send - - X X
1650tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001651tcp-request connection - X X -
1652tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001653tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001654tcp-response content - - X X
1655tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001656timeout check X - X X
1657timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001658timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001659timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1660timeout connect X - X X
1661timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1662timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1663timeout http-request X X X X
1664timeout queue X - X X
1665timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001666timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001667timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1668timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001669timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001670transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001671unique-id-format X X X -
1672unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001673use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001674use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001675------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1676 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001677
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016794.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1680---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001681
1682This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1683
1684
1685acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1686 Declare or complete an access list.
1687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1688 no | yes | yes | yes
1689 Example:
1690 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1691 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1692 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001694 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695
1696
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001697appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1698 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001699 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1701 no | no | yes | yes
1702 Arguments :
1703 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1704 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1705
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001706 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001707 checked in each cookie value.
1708
1709 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1710 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1711 milliseconds.
1712
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001713 request-learn
1714 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1715 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1716 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1717 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1718 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1719 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1720
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001721 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1722 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1723 data following this prefix.
1724
1725 Example :
1726 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1727
1728 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1729 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1730
1731 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1732 2 modes are currently supported :
1733 - path-parameters :
1734 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1735 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1736 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1737 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1738 - query-string :
1739 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1740 query string.
1741
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001742 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1743 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1744 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1745 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001746 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1747 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1748 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001749 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1750 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1751
1752 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1753
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001754 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1755 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1756 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001758 Example :
1759 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1760
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001761 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1762 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001763
1764
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001765backlog <conns>
1766 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1768 yes | yes | yes | no
1769 Arguments :
1770 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1771 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001772 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001773
1774 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1775 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1776 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1777 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1778 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1779 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1780 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1781 backlog parameter.
1782
1783 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1784 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1785 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1786
1787 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1788
1789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001790balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001791balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001792 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1794 yes | no | yes | yes
1795 Arguments :
1796 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1797 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1798 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1799 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1800
1801 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1802 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1803 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1804 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001805 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001806 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001807 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1808 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1809 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1810 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1811 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1812 it, so that you don't worry.
1813
1814 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1815 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1816 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1817 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1818 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1819 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1820 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1821 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001822
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001823 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1824 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1825 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1826 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1827 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1828 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1829 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1830 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1831
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001832 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001833 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001834 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1835 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001836 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001837 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1838 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1839 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1840 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1841 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001842 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1843 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1844 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1845 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1846 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1847 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001848
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001849 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1850 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1851 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1852 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1853 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1854 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1855 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1856 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001857 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001858 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001859 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1860 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1861 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001862
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001863 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1864 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1865 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1866 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1867 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1868 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1869 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1870 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1871 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1872 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1873 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1874 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001875
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001876 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001877 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1878 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1879 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1880 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1881 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1882 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1883 URIs start with a leading "/".
1884
1885 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1886 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1887 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1888 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1889
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001890 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001891 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1892
1893 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001894 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1895 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001896 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1897 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1898 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1899 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001900 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001901 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1902 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001903
1904 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1905 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1906 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1907 server will receive the request.
1908
1909 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1910 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1911 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1912 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1913 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001914 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1915 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1916 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001917
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001918 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1919 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1920 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1921 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1922 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001924 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001925 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1926 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1927 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1928
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001929 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1930 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1931 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1932
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001933 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001934 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001935 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1936 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1937 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1938 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1939 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1940 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001941 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001942 used instead.
1943
1944 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1945 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1946 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1947 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1948
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001949 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1950 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1951 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1952
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001953 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001954
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001955 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001956 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1957 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001958
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001959 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1960 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1961 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001962
1963 Examples :
1964 balance roundrobin
1965 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001966 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001967 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1968 balance hdr(host)
1969 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001970
1971 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1972 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001974 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001975 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1976 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1977 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1978 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1979
1980 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1981 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1982 defaults to 16 kB.
1983
1984 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1985 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1986
1987 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1988 Round Robin.
1989
1990 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1991 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1992 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1993 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1994
1995 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1996
1997 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001998 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001999 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2000 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2001 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002003 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
2004 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002005
2006
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002007bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2008bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002009 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2011 no | yes | yes | no
2012 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002013 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2014 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2015 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2016 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002017 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002018 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2019 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2020 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2021 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2022 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2023 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2024 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002025 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2026 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2027 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2028 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2029 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2030 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2031 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002032 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2033 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2034 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002035 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2036 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2037 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002038
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002039 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2040 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002041 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2042 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2043 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002044 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2045 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2046 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2047 the range.
2048
2049 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2050 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2051 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2052 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2053 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2054 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2055 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002056 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002057 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002058
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002059 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2060 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2061 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2062 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2063 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2064 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2065 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2066 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2067
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002068 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2069 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2070 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2071 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002072
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002073 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2074 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2075 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2076 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2077 in a frontend.
2078
2079 Example :
2080 listen http_proxy
2081 bind :80,:443
2082 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002083 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002085 listen http_https_proxy
2086 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002087 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002088
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002089 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2090 bind ipv6@:80
2091 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2092 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2093
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002094 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002095 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002096
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002097 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002098 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002099
2100
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002101bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002102 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2104 yes | yes | yes | yes
2105 Arguments :
2106 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2107 may be used to override a default value.
2108
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002109 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002110 option may be combined with other numbers.
2111
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002112 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002113 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2114 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2115 missing from all processes.
2116
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002117 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002118 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002119 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2120 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2121 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2122 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002123
2124 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2125 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2126 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2127 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2128 and 'even' instances.
2129
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002130 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2131 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2132 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2133 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002134
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002135 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2136 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2137
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002138 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2139 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2140 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2141
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002142 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2143 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2144
2145 Example :
2146 listen app_ip1
2147 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002148 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002149
2150 listen app_ip2
2151 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002152 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002153
2154 listen management
2155 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002156 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002157
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002158 listen management
2159 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2160 bind-process 1-4
2161
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002162 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002163
2164
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002165block { if | unless } <condition>
2166 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2168 no | yes | yes | yes
2169
2170 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2171 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002172 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002173 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002174 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2175 "block" statements per instance.
2176
2177 Example:
2178 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2179 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2180 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2181 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002183 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002184
2185
2186capture cookie <name> len <length>
2187 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2189 no | yes | yes | no
2190 Arguments :
2191 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2192 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2193 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2194 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2195 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2196
2197 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2198 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2199 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2200 right if it exceeds <length>.
2201
2202 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2203 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2204 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2205 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2206
2207 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2208 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2209 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2210
2211 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2212 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2213 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002214 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2215 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2216 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002217
2218 Example:
2219 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2220
2221 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002222 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002223
2224
2225capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002226 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2228 no | yes | yes | no
2229 Arguments :
2230 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002231 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002232 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2233 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2234 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2235
2236 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2237 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2238 it exceeds <length>.
2239
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002240 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002241 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2242 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002243 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2244 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2245 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2246 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002247 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002248 environments to find where the request came from.
2249
2250 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2251 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2252 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2253 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002254
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002255 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2256 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2257 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2258 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2259 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002260
2261 Example:
2262 capture request header Host len 15
2263 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2264 capture request header Referrer len 15
2265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002266 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002267 about logging.
2268
2269
2270capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002271 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2273 no | yes | yes | no
2274 Arguments :
2275 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002276 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002277 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2278 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2279 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2280
2281 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2282 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2283 it exceeds <length>.
2284
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002285 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002286 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2287 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2288 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002289 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2290 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2291 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2292 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002293
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002294 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2295 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2296 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2297 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2298 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299
2300 Example:
2301 capture response header Content-length len 9
2302 capture response header Location len 15
2303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002304 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002305 about logging.
2306
2307
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002308clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002309 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2311 yes | yes | yes | no
2312 Arguments :
2313 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2314 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2315 as explained at the top of this document.
2316
2317 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2318 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2319 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2320 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2321 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2322 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2323 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2324 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002325 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002326 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2327 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2328
2329 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2330 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2331 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2332 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2333 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2334 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2335
2336 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2337 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2338
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002339 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2340 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002341
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002342compression algo <algorithm> ...
2343compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002344compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002345 Enable HTTP compression.
2346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2347 yes | yes | yes | yes
2348 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002349 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2350 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2351 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2352
2353 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002354 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2355 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2356 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002357
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002358 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2359 support for zlib was built in.
2360
2361 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2362 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2363 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2364 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2365 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2366 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002367
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002368 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2369 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2370 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2371 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2372 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2373 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2374 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2375 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002376
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002377 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002378 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002379 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2380 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2381 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2382 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2383 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002384
2385 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2386 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2387 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2388 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2389 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002390 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2391 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2392 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2393 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2394 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002395 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2396 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002397
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002398 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002399 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2400 "Accept-Encoding" header
2401 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002402 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002403 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2404 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002405 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2406 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2407 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2408 "multipart"
2409 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2410 header
2411 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2412 and later
2413 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2414 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002415
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002416 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2417 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002418
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002419 Examples :
2420 compression algo gzip
2421 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002422
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002423contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002424 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2426 yes | no | yes | yes
2427 Arguments :
2428 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2429 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2430 as explained at the top of this document.
2431
2432 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002433 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002434 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002435 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2436 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2437 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2438 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2439
2440 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2441 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2442 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2443 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2444 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2445 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2446
2447 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2448 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2449 instead.
2450
2451 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2452 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2453
2454
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002455cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002456 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2457 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002458 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2460 yes | no | yes | yes
2461 Arguments :
2462 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2463 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2464 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2465 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2466 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2467 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2468 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2469 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2470 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2471
2472 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2473 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2474 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2475 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2476 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2477 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2478 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2479 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2480 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2481 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2482 "insert" and "prefix".
2483
2484 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002485 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002486
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002487 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002488 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2489 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2490 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2491 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2492 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2493 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2494 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2495 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2496 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2497 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002498
2499 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2500 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2501 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2502 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2503 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2504 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2505 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2506 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2507 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2508 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002509 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2510 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2511 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002512
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002513 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2514 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2515 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002516 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2517 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2518 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2519 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002520 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2521 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2522 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002523
2524 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2525 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2526 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2527 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2528 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2529 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2530 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2531 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2532 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2533
2534 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2535 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2536 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2537 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2538 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2539 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2540 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2541 persistence cookie in the cache.
2542 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2543
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002544 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2545 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2546 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2547 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2548 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2549 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2550 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2551 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2552 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2553 they logout.
2554
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002555 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2556 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2557 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2558 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2559
2560 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2561 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2562 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2563 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2564 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2565 this attribute.
2566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002567 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002568 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002569 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2570 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2571 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2572 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2573 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2574 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002575
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002576 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2577 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2578 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2579 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2580 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2581 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2582 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2583 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2584 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2585 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2586 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2587 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2588 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2589 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2590 the site.
2591
2592 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2593 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2594 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2595 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2596 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2597 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2598 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2599 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2600 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2601 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2602 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2603 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2604 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2605 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2606 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2607 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2608
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002609 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2610 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2611 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2612 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002613
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002614 Examples :
2615 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2616 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2617 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002618 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002619
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002620 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002621 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002622
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002623
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002624default-server [param*]
2625 Change default options for a server in a backend
2626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2627 yes | no | yes | yes
2628 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002629 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2630 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2631 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2632 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002633
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002634 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002635 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2636
2637 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002638
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002639
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002640default_backend <backend>
2641 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2643 yes | yes | yes | no
2644 Arguments :
2645 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2646
2647 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2648 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2649 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2650 will catch all undetermined requests.
2651
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002652 Example :
2653
2654 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2655 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2656 default_backend dynamic
2657
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002658 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2659
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002660
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002661description <string>
2662 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2664 no | yes | yes | yes
2665 Arguments : string
2666
2667 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2668 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2669 it describes.
2670 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2671
2672
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002673disabled
2674 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2676 yes | yes | yes | yes
2677 Arguments : none
2678
2679 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2680 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2681 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2682 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2683 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2684 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2685 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2686
2687 See also : "enabled"
2688
2689
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002690dispatch <address>:<port>
2691 Set a default server address
2692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2693 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002694 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002695
2696 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2697 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2698 during start-up.
2699
2700 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2701 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2702 possible with normal servers.
2703
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002704 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002705 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2706 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2707 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2708 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2709
2710 See also : "server"
2711
2712
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002713enabled
2714 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2716 yes | yes | yes | yes
2717 Arguments : none
2718
2719 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2720 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2721
2722 See also : "disabled"
2723
2724
2725errorfile <code> <file>
2726 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2728 yes | yes | yes | yes
2729 Arguments :
2730 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002731 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2732 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002733
2734 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002735 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002736 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002737 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2738 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002739
2740 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2741 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2742 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2743
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002744 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2745
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002746 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2747 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2748 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2749 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2750
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002751 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2752 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2753 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2754 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2755 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2756 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002758 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2759 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2760 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002761 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002762 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2763
2764 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2765
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002766 Example :
2767 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002768 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002769 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2770 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2771
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002772
2773errorloc <code> <url>
2774errorloc302 <code> <url>
2775 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2777 yes | yes | yes | yes
2778 Arguments :
2779 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002780 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002781
2782 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2783 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2784 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2785 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2786 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2787
2788 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2789 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2790 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2791
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002792 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2793
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002794 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2795 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2796 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2797 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2798 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2799 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2800 request.
2801
2802 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2803
2804
2805errorloc303 <code> <url>
2806 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2808 yes | yes | yes | yes
2809 Arguments :
2810 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2811 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2812
2813 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2814 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2815 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2816 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2817 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2818
2819 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2820 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2821 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2822
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002823 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2824
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002825 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2826 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2827 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2828 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002829 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002830
2831 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2832
2833
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002834email-alert from <emailaddr>
2835 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2836 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2837 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2838 yes | yes | yes | yes
2839
2840 Arguments :
2841
2842 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2843
2844 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2845 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2846
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002847 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2848 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2849
2850
2851email-alert level <level>
2852 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2853 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2854 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2855 yes | yes | yes | yes
2856
2857 Arguments :
2858
2859 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2860 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2861 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2862
2863 By default level is alert
2864
2865 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2866 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2867 for the proxy.
2868
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09002869 Alerts are sent when :
2870
2871 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
2872 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
2873 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
2874 is notice or lower
2875 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
2876 and a health check status update occurs
2877
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002878 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2879 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002880 section 3.6 about mailers.
2881
2882
2883email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2884 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2885 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2886 yes | yes | yes | yes
2887
2888 Arguments :
2889
2890 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2891
2892 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2893 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2894
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002895 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
2896 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002897
2898
2899email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2900 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2901 mailers.
2902 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2903 yes | yes | yes | yes
2904
2905 Arguments :
2906
2907 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2908
2909 By default the systems hostname is used.
2910
2911 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2912 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2913 for the proxy.
2914
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002915 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2916 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002917
2918
2919email-alert to <emailaddr>
2920 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
2921 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
2922 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2923 yes | yes | yes | yes
2924
2925 Arguments :
2926
2927 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2928
2929 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2930 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2931
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002932 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002933 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
2934
2935
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002936force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2937 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2938 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2939 no | yes | yes | yes
2940
2941 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2942 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2943 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2944 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2945 marked down for maintenance operations.
2946
2947 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2948 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2949 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2950 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2951 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2952 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2953 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2954 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2955 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2956
2957 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2958 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2959 is used.
2960
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002961 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002962 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002963
2964
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002965fullconn <conns>
2966 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2968 yes | no | yes | yes
2969 Arguments :
2970 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2971 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2972
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002973 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002974 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002975 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002976 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2977 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2978 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2979 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2980 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002981 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002982
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002983 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2984 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002985 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2986 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2987 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002988
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002989 Example :
2990 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2991 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2992 # connections.
2993 backend dynamic
2994 fullconn 10000
2995 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2996 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2997
2998 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2999
3000
3001grace <time>
3002 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003004 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003005 Arguments :
3006 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3007 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3008 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3009
3010 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3011 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003012 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003013 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3014
3015 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3016 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3017 simplify it.
3018
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003019
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003020hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003021 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3023 yes | no | yes | yes
3024 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003025 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3026 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003027
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003028 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3029 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3030 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3031 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3032 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3033 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3034 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3035 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3036 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3037 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003038
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003039 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3040 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3041 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3042 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3043 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3044 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3045 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3046 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3047 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3048 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3049 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3050 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3051 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003052 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3053 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003054
3055 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3056
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003057 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003058 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3059 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3060 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003061 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3062 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3063 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003064
3065 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3066 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003067 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3068 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3069 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3070 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3071
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003072 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3073 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3074 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3075 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3076 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3077 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3078 parameter.
3079
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003080 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3081 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3082 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3083 used on strings.
3084
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003085 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3086
3087 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3088 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3089 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3090 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3091 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3092 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3093 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3094 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3095 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3096 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3097 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3098 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003099
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003100 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3101 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3102 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003103
3104 See also : "balance", "server"
3105
3106
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003107http-check disable-on-404
3108 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003110 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003111 Arguments : none
3112
3113 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3114 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3115 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3116 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3117 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3118 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3119 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3120 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003121 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3122 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3123 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3124
3125 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3126
3127
3128http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003129 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003131 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003132 Arguments :
3133 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3134 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003135 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003136 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3137 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3138 details on the supported keywords.
3139
3140 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3141 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3142 with the usual backslash ('\').
3143
3144 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3145 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3146 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3147 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3148 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3149
3150 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003151 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003152 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3153 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3154 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3155
3156 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003157 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003158 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3159 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3160 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3161 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3162
3163 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003164 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003165 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3166 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3167 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3168 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3169 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3170 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3171 trace).
3172
3173 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003174 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003175 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3176 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3177 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3178 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3179 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3180 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3181
3182 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3183 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3184 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3185 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3186 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3187 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3188 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3189 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3190
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003191 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3192 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3193 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3194
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003195 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3196 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3197
3198 Examples :
3199 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003200 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003201
3202 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003203 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003204
3205 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003206 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003207
3208 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003209 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003210
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003211 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003212
3213
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003214http-check send-state
3215 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3217 yes | no | yes | yes
3218 Arguments : none
3219
3220 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3221 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3222 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3223 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3224 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3225
3226 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3227 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3228 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3229 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3230 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003231 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3232 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3233 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3234
3235 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3236 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3237 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3238
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003239 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3240 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3241 checked in multiple backends.
3242
3243 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3244 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3245
3246 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3247 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3248 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3249 one fails.
3250
3251 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3252 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3253 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3254
3255 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3256 server's queue.
3257
3258 Example of a header received by the application server :
3259 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3260 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3261
3262 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3263
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003264http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003265 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003266 capture <sample> len <length> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003267 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003268 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3269 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003270 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3271 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003272 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3273 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3274 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003275 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003276 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3277 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003278 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003279 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003280 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3281
3282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3283 no | yes | yes | yes
3284
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003285 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3286 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3287 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3288 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3289 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003290
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003291 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3292 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3293 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3294
3295 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3296 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3297 are evaluated.
3298
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003299 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3300 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3301 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3302 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3303 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3304 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3305 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3306 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3307 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003308 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003309 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3310
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003311 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3312 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3313 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3314 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3315 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3316
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003317 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3318 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3319 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003320 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3321 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003322
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003323 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3324 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3325 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3326 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3327 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3328 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3329 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3330 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3331
3332 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3333 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3334 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003335 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3336 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003337
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003338 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3339 <name>.
3340
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003341 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3342 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3343 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3344 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3345 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3346 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3347 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3348 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3349
3350 Example:
3351
3352 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3353
3354 applied to:
3355
3356 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3357
3358 outputs:
3359
3360 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3361
3362 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3363
3364 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3365 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3366 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3367 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3368 header.
3369
3370 Example:
3371
3372 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3373
3374 applied to:
3375
3376 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3377
3378 outputs:
3379
3380 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3381
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003382 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3383 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3384 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3385 it.
3386
3387 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3388 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3389 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3390 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3391 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3392 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3393
3394 Example :
3395 # prepend the host name before the path
3396 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3397
3398 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3399 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3400 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3401 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3402 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3403 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3404 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3405 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3406
3407 Example :
3408 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3409 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3410
3411 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3412 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3413 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3414 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3415 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3416 "set-query".
3417
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003418 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3419 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3420 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3421 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3422 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3423 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3424 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3425 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3426
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003427 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3428 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3429 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3430 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3431 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3432 another equipment.
3433
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003434 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3435 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3436 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3437 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3438 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3439 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3440 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3441 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3442
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003443 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3444 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3445 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3446 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3447 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3448 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3449 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3450 admin privileges.
3451
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003452 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3453 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3454 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3455 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3456 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3457 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3458 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3459 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3460
3461 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3462 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3463 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3464 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3465 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3466 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3467
3468 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3469 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3470 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3471 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3472 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3473 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3474
3475 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3476 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3477 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3478 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3479 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3480 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3481 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3482 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3483 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3484
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003485 - capture <sample> len <length> :
3486 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3487 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3488 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3489 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3490 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3491 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3492 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3493 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3494 request header" for more information.
3495
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003496 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3497 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3498 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3499 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3500 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3501 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3502 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3503 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3504 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3505 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3506 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3507 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3508
3509 These actions take one or two arguments :
3510 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3511 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3512 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3513 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3514
3515 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3516 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3517 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3518 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3519
3520 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3521 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3522 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3523 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3524 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3525 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3526 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3527 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3528
3529 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3530 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3531 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3532 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3533 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3534
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003535 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3536 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3537 function is documented in the API documentation.
3538
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003539 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3540
3541 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3542 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3543 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3544 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003545
3546 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003547 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3548 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3549 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003550
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003551 http-request allow if nagios
3552 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3553 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3554 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003555
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003556 Example:
3557 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003558 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003559
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003560 Example:
3561 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3562 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3563 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3564 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3565 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3566 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3567 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3568 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3569 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3570
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003571 Example:
3572 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3573 acl add path /addacl
3574 acl del path /delacl
3575
3576 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3577
3578 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3579 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3580
3581 Example:
3582 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3583 acl setmap path /setmap
3584 acl delmap path /delmap
3585
3586 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3587
3588 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3589 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3590
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003591 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3592 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003593
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003594http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003595 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003596 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3597 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003598 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3599 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3600 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3601 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003602 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
3603 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003604 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003605 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003606 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3607
3608 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3609 no | yes | yes | yes
3610
3611 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3612 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3613 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3614 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3615 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3616 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3617
3618 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3619 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3620 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3621 current section.
3622
3623 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3624 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3625 rules are evaluated.
3626
3627 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3628 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3629 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3630 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3631 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3632 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3633 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3634
3635 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3636 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3637 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3638 external users.
3639
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003640 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3641 <name>.
3642
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003643 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3644 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3645 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3646 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3647 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3648 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3649 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3650 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3651
3652 Example:
3653
3654 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3655
3656 applied to:
3657
3658 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3659
3660 outputs:
3661
3662 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3663
3664 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3665
3666 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3667 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3668 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3669 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3670 header.
3671
3672 Example:
3673
3674 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3675
3676 applied to:
3677
3678 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3679
3680 outputs:
3681
3682 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3683
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003684 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3685 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3686 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3687 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3688 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3689 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3690 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3691 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3692
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003693 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3694 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3695 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3696 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3697 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3698 another equipment.
3699
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003700 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3701 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3702 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3703 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3704 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3705 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3706 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3707 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3708
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003709 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3710 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3711 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3712 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3713 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3714 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3715 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3716 admin privileges.
3717
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003718 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3719 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3720 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3721 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3722 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3723 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3724 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3725 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3726
3727 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3728 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3729 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3730 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3731 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3732 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3733
3734 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3735 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3736 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3737 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3738 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3739 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3740
3741 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3742 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3743 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3744 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3745 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3746 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3747 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3748 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3749 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3750
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003751 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3752 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3753 function is documented in the API documentation.
3754
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003755 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3756
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003757 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003758 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3759 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3760 rules.
3761
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003762 Example:
3763 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3764
3765 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3766
3767 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3768 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3769
3770 Example:
3771 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3772
3773 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3774
3775 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3776 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3777
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003778 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3779 ACL usage.
3780
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003781
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003782http-send-name-header [<header>]
3783 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3784
3785 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3786 yes | no | yes | yes
3787
3788 Arguments :
3789
3790 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3791
3792 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3793 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3794 is added with the header string proved.
3795
3796 See also : "server"
3797
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003798id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003799 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 no | yes | yes | yes
3802 Arguments : none
3803
3804 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3805 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3806 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003807
3808
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003809ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3810 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3811 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3812 no | yes | yes | yes
3813
3814 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3815 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3816 and running).
3817
3818 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3819 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3820 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003821 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003822 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3823
3824 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3825 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3826
3827 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3828 "unless" condition is met.
3829
3830 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3831
3832
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003833log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003834log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003835no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003836 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3838 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003839
3840 Prefix :
3841 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3842 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3843 prefix does not allow arguments.
3844
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003845 Arguments :
3846 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3847 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3848 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3849 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3850 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3851 parameter.
3852
3853 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3854 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3855
3856 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3857 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3858 standard syslog port).
3859
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003860 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3861 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3862 standard syslog port).
3863
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003864 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3865 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3866 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3867 appropriately writeable).
3868
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003869 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3870 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003871
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003872 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3873 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3874 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3875 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3876 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3877 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3878 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3879 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3880 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3881 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3882 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3883
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003884 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3885
3886 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3887 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3888 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3889
3890 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3891 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3892 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003893 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3894 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3895 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3896 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3897 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003898
3899 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3900
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003901 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3902 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3903 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003904
3905 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3906 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3907 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3908 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3909
3910 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3911 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003912
3913 Example :
3914 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003915 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3916 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003917 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003918
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003919
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003920log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003921 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3922 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3923 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003924
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003925 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3926 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3927 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3928 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3929 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003930
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003931log-tag <string>
3932 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
3933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | yes | yes | yes
3935
3936 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
3937 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
3938 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
3939 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
3940 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
3941 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
3942 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
3943 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
3944 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003945
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003946max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3947 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3948 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3949 yes | no | yes | yes
3950
3951 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3952 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3953 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3954 servers.
3955
3956 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3957 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3958 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3959 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3960 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3961 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3962 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3963 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3964 picking a different server.
3965
3966 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3967 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3968 even if they have to be queued.
3969
3970 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3971 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3972
3973
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003974maxconn <conns>
3975 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3977 yes | yes | yes | no
3978 Arguments :
3979 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3980 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3981 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3982 closes.
3983
3984 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3985 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3986 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3987 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3988 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3989 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3990 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3991 properly tuned.
3992
3993 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3994 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3995 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3996
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003997 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3998
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003999 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4000
4001
4002mode { tcp|http|health }
4003 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4005 yes | yes | yes | yes
4006 Arguments :
4007 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4008 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4009 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4010 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4011
4012 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4013 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4014 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4015 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4016 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4017
4018 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004019 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4020 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4021 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4022 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4023 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4024 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4025 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004026
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004027 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4028 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4029 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004030
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004031 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004032 defaults http_instances
4033 mode http
4034
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004035 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004036
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004037
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004038monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004039 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4041 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004042 Arguments :
4043 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4044 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004045 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004046 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4047 backend and its backup.
4048
4049 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4050 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4051 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4052 servers in a list of backends.
4053
4054 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4055 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4056 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4057 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4058 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4059 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4060 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004061 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4062 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004063
4064 Example:
4065 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004066 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004067 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4068 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4069 monitor-uri /site_alive
4070 monitor fail if site_dead
4071
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004072 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004073
4074
4075monitor-net <source>
4076 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4078 yes | yes | yes | no
4079 Arguments :
4080 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4081 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4082 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4083 followed by a mask.
4084
4085 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4086 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004087 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004088 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4089
4090 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4091 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4092 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4093 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004094 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4095 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4096 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004097
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004098 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4099 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4100 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4101 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4102 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4103 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004104
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004105 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4106 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004107
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004108 Example :
4109 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4110 frontend www
4111 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4112
4113 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4114
4115
4116monitor-uri <uri>
4117 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4119 yes | yes | yes | no
4120 Arguments :
4121 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4122 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4123
4124 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4125 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4126 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4127 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4128 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4129 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4130 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4131 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4132
4133 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4134 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4135 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4136 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4137 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4138 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4139
4140 Example :
4141 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4142 frontend www
4143 mode http
4144 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4145
4146 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4147
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004148
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004149option abortonclose
4150no option abortonclose
4151 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4153 yes | no | yes | yes
4154 Arguments : none
4155
4156 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4157 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4158 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4159 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004160 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004161 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4162 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4163 encountered while delivering the response.
4164
4165 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4166 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4167 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4168 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4169 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4170 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004171 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004172 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004173 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004174 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4175 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4176 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4177
4178 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4179 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4180 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4181 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4182 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4183 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4184 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4185 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004186 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004187
4188 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4189 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4190
4191 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4192
4193
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004194option accept-invalid-http-request
4195no option accept-invalid-http-request
4196 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4198 yes | yes | yes | no
4199 Arguments : none
4200
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004201 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004202 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4203 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4204 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4205 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4206 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4207 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4208 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004209 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4210 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4211 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4212 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4213 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004214 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004215 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4216 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4217 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004218
4219 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4220 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4221 been confirmed.
4222
4223 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4224 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004225 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4226 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004227 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4228
4229 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4230 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4231
4232 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4233 stats socket.
4234
4235
4236option accept-invalid-http-response
4237no option accept-invalid-http-response
4238 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4240 yes | no | yes | yes
4241 Arguments : none
4242
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004243 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004244 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4245 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4246 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4247 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4248 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4249 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4250 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004251 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4252 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4253 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004254
4255 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4256 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4257 been confirmed.
4258
4259 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4260 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4261 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4262 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4263
4264 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4265 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4266
4267 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4268 stats socket.
4269
4270
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004271option allbackups
4272no option allbackups
4273 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4275 yes | no | yes | yes
4276 Arguments : none
4277
4278 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4279 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4280 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4281 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4282 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4283 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4284 order between the backup servers anymore.
4285
4286 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4287 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4288
4289 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4290 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4291
4292
4293option checkcache
4294no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004295 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4297 yes | no | yes | yes
4298 Arguments : none
4299
4300 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4301 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004302 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004303 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4304 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004305 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004306
4307 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004308 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004309 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004310 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4311 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004312 to the client are :
4313 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004314 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004315 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004316 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4317 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4318 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4319 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4320 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4321 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4322 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4323 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4324 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4325 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4326 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4327
4328 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004329 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004330 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004331 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004332 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4333
4334 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4335 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004336 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004337 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4338
4339 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4340 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4341
4342
4343option clitcpka
4344no option clitcpka
4345 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4347 yes | yes | yes | no
4348 Arguments : none
4349
4350 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4351 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4352 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4353 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4354
4355 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4356 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4357 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4358 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4359
4360 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4361 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4362 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4363 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4364 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4365
4366 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4367
4368 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4369 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4370 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4371
4372 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4373 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4374
4375 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4376
4377
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004378option contstats
4379 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4381 yes | yes | yes | no
4382 Arguments : none
4383
4384 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4385 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4386 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4387 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4388 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4389 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4390 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4391
4392
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004393option dontlog-normal
4394no option dontlog-normal
4395 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4397 yes | yes | yes | no
4398 Arguments : none
4399
4400 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4401 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4402 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4403 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4404 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4405 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4406 logged.
4407
4408 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4409 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4410 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004412 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004413 logging.
4414
4415
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004416option dontlognull
4417no option dontlognull
4418 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4420 yes | yes | yes | no
4421 Arguments : none
4422
4423 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4424 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4425 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4426 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4427 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4428 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004429 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4430 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4431 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004432
4433 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4434 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4435 would not be logged.
4436
4437 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4438 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4439
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004440 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4441 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004442
4443
4444option forceclose
4445no option forceclose
4446 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004448 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004449 Arguments : none
4450
4451 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4452 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4453 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4454 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4455 global session times in the logs.
4456
4457 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004458 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004459 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004460
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004461 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4462 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4463 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4464
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004465 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4466 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004467
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004468 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4469 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4470
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004471 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004472
4473
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004474option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004475 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4477 yes | yes | yes | yes
4478 Arguments :
4479 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4480 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004481 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004482 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004483
4484 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4485 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4486 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4487 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4488 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4489 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4490 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004491 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4492 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4493 possible that the client has already brought one.
4494
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004495 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004496 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004497 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4498 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004499 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4500 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004501
4502 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4503 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4504 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4505 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4506 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4507 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4508 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4509
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004510 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4511 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4512 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4513 are under the control of the end-user.
4514
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004515 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004516 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4517 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004518 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4519 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4520 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004521
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004522 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004523 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4524 frontend www
4525 mode http
4526 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4527
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004528 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4529 backend www
4530 mode http
4531 option forwardfor header X-Client
4532
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004533 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004534 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004535
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004536
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004537option http-buffer-request
4538no option http-buffer-request
4539 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
4540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4541 yes | yes | yes | yes
4542 Arguments : none
4543
4544 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
4545 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
4546 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
4547 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
4548 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
4549 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
4550 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
4551 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
4552 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
4553 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
4554 default.
4555
4556 See also : "option http-no-delay"
4557
4558
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004559option http-ignore-probes
4560no option http-ignore-probes
4561 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4563 yes | yes | yes | no
4564 Arguments : none
4565
4566 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4567 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4568 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4569 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4570 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4571 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4572 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4573 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4574 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4575 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4576 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4577 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4578
4579 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4580 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4581 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4582 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4583 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4584 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4585 are often the only way to detect them.
4586
4587 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4588 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4589
4590 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4591
4592
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004593option http-keep-alive
4594no option http-keep-alive
4595 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4597 yes | yes | yes | yes
4598 Arguments : none
4599
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004600 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4601 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4602 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4603 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4604 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4605 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4606 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4607
4608 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4609 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004610 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4611 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4612 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4613 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4614 situations where this option may be useful :
4615
4616 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4617 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4618
4619 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4620 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4621
4622 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4623 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4624 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4625 request.
4626
4627 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4628 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004629 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4630 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4631 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004632
4633 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4634 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4635
4636 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4637 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4638 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4639 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4640 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4641 not set.
4642
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004643 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4644 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004645 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004646 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004647
4648 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004649 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4650 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004651
4652
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004653option http-no-delay
4654no option http-no-delay
4655 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4657 yes | yes | yes | yes
4658 Arguments : none
4659
4660 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4661 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4662 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4663 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4664 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4665 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4666 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4667 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4668 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4669 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4670 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4671 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4672 affected.
4673
4674 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4675 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4676 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4677 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4678 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4679 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4680 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4681 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4682 latency environments.
4683
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004684 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
4685
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004686
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004687option http-pretend-keepalive
4688no option http-pretend-keepalive
4689 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4691 yes | yes | yes | yes
4692 Arguments : none
4693
4694 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4695 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4696 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4697 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4698 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4699 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4700 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4701 consider the response complete.
4702
4703 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4704 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4705 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4706 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4707 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4708 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4709
4710 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4711 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4712 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4713 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4714 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4715 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4716 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4717
4718 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4719 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004720 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004721 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4722 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004723
4724 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4725 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4726
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004727 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4728 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004729
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004730
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004731option http-server-close
4732no option http-server-close
4733 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4735 yes | yes | yes | yes
4736 Arguments : none
4737
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004738 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4739 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4740 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4741 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4742 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4743 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4744 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4745 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4746 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4747 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4748 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4749 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4750 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4751 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4752 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4753 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004754
4755 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4756 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4757 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4758 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004759 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4760 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004761
4762 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4763 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004764 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4765 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004766 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4767 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004768
4769 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4770 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4771
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004772 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004773 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4774 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004775
4776
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004777option http-tunnel
4778no option http-tunnel
4779 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4781 yes | yes | yes | yes
4782 Arguments : none
4783
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004784 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4785 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4786 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4787 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4788 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4789 "option http-tunnel".
4790
4791 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004792 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004793 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4794 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4795 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4796 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4797 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4798 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4799 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004800
4801 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4802 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4803
4804 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4805 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4806 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4807
4808
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004809option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004810no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004811 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4813 yes | yes | yes | no
4814 Arguments : none
4815
4816 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4817 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4818 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4819 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4820 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4821 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4822 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4823
4824 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4825 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4826 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4827 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4828 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4829 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4830 request along its whole life.
4831
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004832 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4833 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4834 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4835 front of an existing proxy.
4836
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004837 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4838
4839 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4840 http-server-close".
4841
4842
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004843option httpchk
4844option httpchk <uri>
4845option httpchk <method> <uri>
4846option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4847 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4849 yes | no | yes | yes
4850 Arguments :
4851 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4852 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4853 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4854 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4855 ones.
4856
4857 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4858 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4859 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4860
4861 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4862 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4863 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4864 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4865 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4866
4867 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4868 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4869 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4870 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4871 the lack of any response.
4872
4873 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4874
4875 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4876 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4877 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4878
4879 Examples :
4880 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4881 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4882 backend https_relay
4883 mode tcp
4884 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4885 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4886
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004887 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4888 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4889 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004890
4891
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004892option httpclose
4893no option httpclose
4894 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4896 yes | yes | yes | yes
4897 Arguments : none
4898
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004899 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4900 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4901 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4902 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004903 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004904 "option http-tunnel".
4905
4906 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4907 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4908 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4909 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4910 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4911 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4912 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4913 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004914
4915 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004916 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004917 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4918 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4919 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4920 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4921 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004922
4923 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4924 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004925 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4926 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004927 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4928 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004929
4930 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4931 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4932
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004933 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4934 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004935
4936
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004937option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004938 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4940 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004941 Arguments :
4942 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4943 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4944 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4945 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4946 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004947
4948 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4949 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4950 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4951 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4952 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4953 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4954 ports.
4955
4956 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4957
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004958 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4959 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004961 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004962
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004963
4964option http_proxy
4965no option http_proxy
4966 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4968 yes | yes | yes | yes
4969 Arguments : none
4970
4971 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4972 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4973 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4974 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4975 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4976
4977 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4978 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4979 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4980 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004981 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004982 be analyzed.
4983
4984 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4985 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4986
4987 Example :
4988 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4989 backend direct_forward
4990 option httpclose
4991 option http_proxy
4992
4993 See also : "option httpclose"
4994
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004995
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004996option independent-streams
4997no option independent-streams
4998 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5000 yes | yes | yes | yes
5001 Arguments : none
5002
5003 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5004 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5005 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5006 receive data or not.
5007
5008 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5009 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5010 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5011 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5012 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5013 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5014 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5015 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5016 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5017 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5018 socket buffers.
5019
5020 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5021 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5022 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5023 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5024 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5025
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005026 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005027 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5028 deprecated.
5029
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005030 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005031
5032
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005033option ldap-check
5034 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5036 yes | no | yes | yes
5037 Arguments : none
5038
5039 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5040 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5041 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5042 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5043
5044 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5045 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5046
5047 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5048 configure it.
5049
5050 Example :
5051 option ldap-check
5052
5053 See also : "option httpchk"
5054
5055
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005056option external-check
5057 Use external processes for server health checks
5058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5059 yes | no | yes | yes
5060
5061 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5062 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5063 command".
5064
5065 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5066
5067 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5068
5069
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005070option log-health-checks
5071no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005072 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5074 yes | no | yes | yes
5075 Arguments : none
5076
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005077 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5078 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5079 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005080
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005081 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5082 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5083 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5084 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5085 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5086
5087 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5088 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005089
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005090 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5091 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5092 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005093
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005094
5095option log-separate-errors
5096no option log-separate-errors
5097 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5099 yes | yes | yes | no
5100 Arguments : none
5101
5102 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5103 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5104 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5105 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5106 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5107 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5108 provides very important information.
5109
5110 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5111 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5112 error logs.
5113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005114 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005115 logging.
5116
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005117
5118option logasap
5119no option logasap
5120 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5122 yes | yes | yes | no
5123 Arguments : none
5124
5125 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5126 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5127 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5128 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5129 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5130 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5131 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005132 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005133 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5134 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5135
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005136 Examples :
5137 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5138 mode http
5139 option httplog
5140 option logasap
5141 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5142
5143 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5144 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5145 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5146 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5147
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005148 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005149 logging.
5150
5151
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005152option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005153 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5155 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005156 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005157 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5158 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005159 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005160
5161 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5162 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5163 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5164 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5165 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5166 in the MySQL table, like this :
5167
5168 USE mysql;
5169 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5170 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5171
5172 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5173 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5174 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5175 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5176 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5177 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5178 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5179 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5180 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5181
5182 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5183 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005184
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005185 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005186
5187 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5188 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5189 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5190 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5191 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
5192 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
5193
5194 See also: "option httpchk"
5195
5196
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005197option nolinger
5198no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005199 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005200 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5201 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005202 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005203
5204 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5205 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5206 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5207 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5208 connections.
5209
5210 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5211 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5212 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5213 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5214 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5215 this too.
5216
5217 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5218 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5219 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5220
5221 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5222 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5223 for servers.
5224
5225 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5226 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5227
5228
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005229option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5230 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5232 yes | yes | yes | yes
5233 Arguments :
5234 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5235 matching <network>
5236 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5237 header name.
5238
5239 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5240 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5241 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5242 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5243 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5244 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5245 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5246 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5247 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5248 possible that the client has already brought one.
5249
5250 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5251 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5252 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5253 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5254 header and requires different one.
5255
5256 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5257 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5258 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5259 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5260 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5261 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5262 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5263
5264 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5265 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5266 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5267 both are defined.
5268
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005269 Examples :
5270 # Original Destination address
5271 frontend www
5272 mode http
5273 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5274
5275 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5276 backend www
5277 mode http
5278 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5279
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005280 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5281 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005282
5283
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005284option persist
5285no option persist
5286 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5287 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5288 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005289 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005290
5291 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5292 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5293 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5294 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5295 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5296 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5297 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5298 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5299 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5300 redirected to another valid server.
5301
5302 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5303 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5304
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005305 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005306
5307
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005308option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5309 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5311 yes | no | yes | yes
5312 Arguments :
5313 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5314 PostgreSQL server.
5315
5316 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5317 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5318 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5319 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5320
5321 See also: "option httpchk"
5322
5323
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005324option prefer-last-server
5325no option prefer-last-server
5326 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5327 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5328 yes | no | yes | yes
5329 Arguments : none
5330
5331 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5332 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5333 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5334 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5335 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5336 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5337 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5338 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5339 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005340 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5341 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5342 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5343 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5344 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5345 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5346 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005347
5348 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5349 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5350
5351 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5352
5353
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005354option redispatch
5355no option redispatch
5356 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5357 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5358 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005359 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005360
5361 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5362 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5363 be able to access the service anymore.
5364
5365 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5366 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5367
5368 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5369 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5370 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005371
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005372 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5373 "redisp" keywords.
5374
5375 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5376 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5377
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005378 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005379
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005380
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005381option redis-check
5382 Use redis health checks for server testing
5383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5384 yes | no | yes | yes
5385 Arguments : none
5386
5387 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5388 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5389 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5390 find the "+PONG" response message.
5391
5392 Example :
5393 option redis-check
5394
5395 See also : "option httpchk"
5396
5397
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005398option smtpchk
5399option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5400 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5402 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005403 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005404 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5405 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5406 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5407
5408 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5409 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5410 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5411
5412 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5413 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5414 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5415 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5416 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5417 dead server.
5418
5419 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5420 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5421 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5422 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5423
5424 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5425 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5426 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5427 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5428 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5429
5430 Example :
5431 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5432
5433 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5434
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005435
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005436option socket-stats
5437no option socket-stats
5438
5439 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5441 yes | yes | yes | no
5442
5443 Arguments : none
5444
5445
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005446option splice-auto
5447no option splice-auto
5448 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5450 yes | yes | yes | yes
5451 Arguments : none
5452
5453 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5454 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5455 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5456 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005457 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005458 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5459 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5460 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5461 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5462
5463 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5464 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5465 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5466 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5467 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5468 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5469 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5470 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5471 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5472 keyword.
5473
5474 Example :
5475 option splice-auto
5476
5477 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5478 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5479
5480 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5481 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5482
5483
5484option splice-request
5485no option splice-request
5486 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5488 yes | yes | yes | yes
5489 Arguments : none
5490
5491 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005492 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005493 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5494 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5495 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5496 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5497
5498 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5499
5500 Example :
5501 option splice-request
5502
5503 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5504 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5505
5506 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5507 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5508
5509
5510option splice-response
5511no option splice-response
5512 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5514 yes | yes | yes | yes
5515 Arguments : none
5516
5517 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005518 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005519 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5520 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5521 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5522 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5523
5524 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5525
5526 Example :
5527 option splice-response
5528
5529 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5530 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5531
5532 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5533 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5534
5535
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005536option srvtcpka
5537no option srvtcpka
5538 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5540 yes | no | yes | yes
5541 Arguments : none
5542
5543 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5544 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5545 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5546 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5547
5548 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5549 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5550 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5551 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5552
5553 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5554 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5555 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5556 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5557 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5558
5559 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5560
5561 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5562 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5563 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5564
5565 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5566 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5567
5568 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5569
5570
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005571option ssl-hello-chk
5572 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5574 yes | no | yes | yes
5575 Arguments : none
5576
5577 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5578 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5579 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5580 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5581 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5582 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5583 hello message.
5584
5585 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5586 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5587 messages, which is appreciable.
5588
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005589 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5590 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5591 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005592
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005593 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5594
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005595
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005596option tcp-check
5597 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5598 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5599 yes | no | yes | yes
5600
5601 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5602 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5603
5604 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5605 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5606 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5607
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005608 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005609 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5610 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5611 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5612 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5613 only.
5614
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005615 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005616 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5617 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5618 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5619 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5620
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005621 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005622 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5623 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005624 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005625 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5626 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5627 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5628 the respective protocols.
5629 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5630 analysed.
5631
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005632 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
5633 script.
5634
5635 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
5636 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
5637 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
5638 The "comment" is of course optional.
5639
5640
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005641 Examples :
5642 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5643 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005644 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005645
5646 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5647 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005648 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005649
5650 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5651 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005652 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005653 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005654 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005655 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005656 tcp-check expect +PONGe
5657 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005658 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5659 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005660 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005661 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5662 tcp-check expect string +OK
5663
5664 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5665 (send many headers before analyzing)
5666 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005667 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005668 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5669 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5670 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5671 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005672 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005673
5674
5675 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5676
5677
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005678option tcp-smart-accept
5679no option tcp-smart-accept
5680 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5682 yes | yes | yes | no
5683 Arguments : none
5684
5685 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5686 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5687 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5688 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5689 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5690 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5691
5692 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5693 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5694 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5695 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5696
5697 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5698 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5699 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5700 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5701
5702 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5703 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5704 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5705
5706 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5707 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5708 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5709
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005710 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5711
5712
5713option tcp-smart-connect
5714no option tcp-smart-connect
5715 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5717 yes | no | yes | yes
5718 Arguments : none
5719
5720 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5721 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5722 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5723 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5724 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5725
5726 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5727 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5728 complex.
5729
5730 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5731 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5732 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5733
5734 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5735 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5736
5737 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5738
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005739
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005740option tcpka
5741 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 yes | yes | yes | yes
5744 Arguments : none
5745
5746 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5747 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5748 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5749 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5750
5751 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5752 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5753 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5754 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5755
5756 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5757 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5758 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5759 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5760 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5761
5762 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5763
5764 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5765 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5766 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5767 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5768 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5769 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5770 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5771 backends.
5772
5773 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5774
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005775
5776option tcplog
5777 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5779 yes | yes | yes | yes
5780 Arguments : none
5781
5782 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5783 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5784 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5785 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5786 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5787 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5788 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5789 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5790
5791 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005793 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005794
5795
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005796option transparent
5797no option transparent
5798 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005800 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005801 Arguments : none
5802
5803 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5804 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5805 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5806 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5807 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5808 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5809 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5810 appropriate server.
5811
5812 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5813 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5814
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005815 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005816 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005817
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005818
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005819external-check command <command>
5820 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5822 yes | no | yes | yes
5823
5824 Arguments :
5825 <command> is the external command to run
5826
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005827 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5828
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005829 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005830
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005831 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5832 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5833 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5834 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5835 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5836 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005837
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005838 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5839
5840 Environment variables :
5841 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5842 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5843
5844 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5845
5846 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5847
5848 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5849 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5850 for a UNIX socket).
5851
5852 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5853
5854 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5855
5856 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5857
5858 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5859
5860 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5861
5862 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5863 socket).
5864
5865 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5866 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5867
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005868 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5869 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5870 failed.
5871
5872 Example :
5873 external-check command /bin/true
5874
5875 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5876
5877
5878external-check path <path>
5879 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5881 yes | no | yes | yes
5882
5883 Arguments :
5884 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5885
5886 The default path is "".
5887
5888 Example :
5889 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5890
5891 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5892 "external-check command"
5893
5894
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005895persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005896persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005897 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5899 yes | no | yes | yes
5900 Arguments :
5901 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005902 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5903 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005904
5905 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5906 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5907 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5908 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5909 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5910 forwarded to this server.
5911
5912 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5913 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5914 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005915 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005916 a single "listen" section.
5917
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005918 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5919 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5920 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5921
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005922 Example :
5923 listen tse-farm
5924 bind :3389
5925 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5926 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5927 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5928 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5929 persist rdp-cookie
5930 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005931 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005932 balance rdp-cookie
5933 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5934 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5935
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005936 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5937 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005938
5939
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005940rate-limit sessions <rate>
5941 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5943 yes | yes | yes | no
5944 Arguments :
5945 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5946 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5947
5948 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5949 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5950 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5951 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5952 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5953 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5954
5955 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5956 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5957 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5958 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5959
5960 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5961 listen smtp
5962 mode tcp
5963 bind :25
5964 rate-limit sessions 10
5965 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5966
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005967 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5968 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5969 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005970
5971 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5972
5973
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005974redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5975redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5976redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005977 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5979 no | yes | yes | yes
5980
5981 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005982 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005983
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005984 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005985 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005986 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5987 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5988 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005989
5990 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5991 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5992 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5993 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5994 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005995 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5996 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5997 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5998 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005999
6000 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6001 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6002 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6003 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6004 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6005 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006006 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006007 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006008 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6009 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6010 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006011
6012 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006013 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6014 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6015 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
6016 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
6017 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6018 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6019 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6020 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006021
6022 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6023 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6024
6025 - "drop-query"
6026 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6027 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6028 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6029 with a location-type redirect.
6030
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006031 - "append-slash"
6032 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6033 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6034 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6035 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6036
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006037 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6038 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6039 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6040 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6041 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6042 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6043 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6044
6045 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6046 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6047 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6048 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6049 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6050 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6051 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006052
6053 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6054 acl clear dst_port 80
6055 acl secure dst_port 8080
6056 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006057 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006058 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006059 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6060
6061 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006062 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6063 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6064 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006065 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006066
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006067 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6068 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6069 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6070
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006071 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006072 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006073
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006074 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
6075 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
6076 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
6077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006078 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006079
6080
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006081redisp (deprecated)
6082redispatch (deprecated)
6083 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6084 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6085 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006086 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006087
6088 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6089 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6090 be able to access the service anymore.
6091
6092 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6093 redistribute them to a working server.
6094
6095 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6096 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6097 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006098
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006099 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6100 "option redispatch" instead.
6101
6102 See also : "option redispatch"
6103
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006104
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006105reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006106 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6108 no | yes | yes | yes
6109 Arguments :
6110 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6111 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006112 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006113
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006114 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6115 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6116
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006117 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6118 the last header of an HTTP request.
6119
6120 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6121 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6122 responses.
6123
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006124 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6125 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6126 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6127
6128 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6129 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006130
6131
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006132reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6133reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006134 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6136 no | yes | yes | yes
6137 Arguments :
6138 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6139 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6140 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6141 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6142 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6143 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6144 ignores case.
6145
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006146 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6147 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6148
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006149 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6150 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6151 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6152 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006153 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006154
6155 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6156 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6157
6158 Example :
6159 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6160 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6161 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6162
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006163 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6164 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006165
6166
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006167reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6168reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006169 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6171 no | yes | yes | yes
6172 Arguments :
6173 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6174 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6175 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6176 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6177 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6178 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6179
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006180 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6181 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6182
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006183 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6184 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6185 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6186 next servers.
6187
6188 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6189 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6190 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6191
6192 Example :
6193 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6194 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6195 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6196
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006197 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6198 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006199
6200
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006201reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6202reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006203 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6205 no | yes | yes | yes
6206 Arguments :
6207 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6208 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6209 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6210 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6211 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6212 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6213 case.
6214
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006215 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6216 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6217
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006218 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6219 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6220 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6221 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006222 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006223
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006224 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006225 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006226 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006227
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006228 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6229 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6230
6231 Example :
6232 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6233 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6234 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6235
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006236 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6237 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006238
6239
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006240reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6241reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006242 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6244 no | yes | yes | yes
6245 Arguments :
6246 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6247 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6248 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6249 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6250 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6251 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6252 case.
6253
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006254 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6255 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6256
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006257 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6258 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6259 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6260 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6261
6262 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6263 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6264
6265 Example :
6266 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6267 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6268 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6269 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6270
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006271 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6272 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006273
6274
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006275reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6276reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006277 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6279 no | yes | yes | yes
6280 Arguments :
6281 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6282 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6283 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6284 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6285 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6286 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6287
6288 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6289 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6290 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6291 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006292 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006293
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006294 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6295 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6296
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006297 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6298 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6299 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6300
6301 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6302 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6303 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6304 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6305 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6306
6307 Example :
6308 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006309 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006310 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6311 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6312
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006313 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6314 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006315
6316
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006317reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6318reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006319 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6321 no | yes | yes | yes
6322 Arguments :
6323 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6324 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6325 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6326 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6327 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6328 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6329 ignores case.
6330
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006331 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6332 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6333
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006334 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6335 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006336 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6337 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6338 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006339 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6340 not set.
6341
6342 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6343 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6344 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6345 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6346 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6347
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006348 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006349 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6350 # block all others.
6351 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6352 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6353
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006354 # block bad guys
6355 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6356 reqitarpit . if badguys
6357
6358 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6359 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006360
6361
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006362retries <value>
6363 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6364 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6365 yes | no | yes | yes
6366 Arguments :
6367 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6368 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6369 default value is 3.
6370
6371 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6372 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6373 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6374
6375 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
6376 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
6377
6378 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6379 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6380
6381 See also : "option redispatch"
6382
6383
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006384rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006385 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6387 no | yes | yes | yes
6388 Arguments :
6389 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6390 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006391 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006392
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006393 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6394 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6395
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006396 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6397 the last header of an HTTP response.
6398
6399 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6400 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6401 responses.
6402
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006403 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6404 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006405
6406
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006407rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6408rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006409 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6411 no | yes | yes | yes
6412 Arguments :
6413 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6414 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6415 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6416 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6417 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6418 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6419 ignores case.
6420
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006421 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6422 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6423
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006424 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6425 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006426 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006427 client.
6428
6429 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6430 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6431 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6432
6433 Example :
6434 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006435 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006436
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006437 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6438 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006439
6440
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006441rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6442rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006443 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6445 no | yes | yes | yes
6446 Arguments :
6447 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6448 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6449 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6450 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6451 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6452 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6453 ignores case.
6454
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006455 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6456 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6457
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006458 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6459 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6460 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6461 case-sensitive.
6462
6463 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006464 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6465 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6466 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006467
6468 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6469 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6470
6471 Example :
6472 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6473 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6474
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006475 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6476 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006477
6478
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006479rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6480rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006481 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6483 no | yes | yes | yes
6484 Arguments :
6485 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6486 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6487 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6488 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6489 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6490 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6491 ignores case.
6492
6493 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6494 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6495 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6496 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006497 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006498
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006499 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6500 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6501
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006502 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6503 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6504 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6505
6506 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6507 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6508 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6509 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6510 are not case-sensitive.
6511
6512 Example :
6513 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6514 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6515
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006516 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6517 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006518
6519
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006520server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006521 Declare a server in a backend
6522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6523 no | no | yes | yes
6524 Arguments :
6525 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006526 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006527 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006528
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006529 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6530 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6531 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6532 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006533 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6534 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6535 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6536 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6537 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006538 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6539 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6540 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6541 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6542 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6543 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6544 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006545 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006546 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6547 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
6548 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006549
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006550 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006551 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6552 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6553 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6554 adding this value to the client's port.
6555
6556 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6557 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006558 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006559
6560 Examples :
6561 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6562 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006563 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006564 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
6565 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
6566 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006567
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006568 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6569 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006570
6571
6572source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006573source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006574source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006575 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6577 yes | no | yes | yes
6578 Arguments :
6579 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6580 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006581
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006582 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006583 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6584 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6585 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6586 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6587 supported prefixes are :
6588 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6589 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6590 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006591 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006592 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
6593 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006594
6595 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6596 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006597 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6598 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6599 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006600
6601 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6602 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6603 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6604 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6605 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6606 <addr>.
6607
6608 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6609 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6610 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6611 port.
6612
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006613 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6614 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6615 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6616 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006617 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006618 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6619 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6620 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6621 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6622 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6623 HTTP header.
6624
6625 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6626 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006627 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006628 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6629 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6630 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6631 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6632 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6633 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6634 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6635
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006636 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6637 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6638 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6639 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6640 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6641 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6642
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006643 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6644 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6645 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6646 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6647
6648 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6649 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6650 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6651 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6652 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6653 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6654
6655 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6656 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6657 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6658 there are two methods :
6659
6660 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6661 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6662 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6663 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6664 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6665 of the client ranges may be used.
6666
6667 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6668 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6669 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6670 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6671 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6672 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6673 same session.
6674
6675 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6676 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6677 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6678 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6679 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6680 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6681
6682 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6683 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6684 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006685 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006686
6687 Examples :
6688 backend private
6689 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6690 source 192.168.1.200
6691
6692 backend transparent_ssl1
6693 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6694 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6695
6696 backend transparent_ssl2
6697 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6698 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6699 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6700
6701 backend transparent_ssl3
6702 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6703 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6704 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6705
6706 backend transparent_smtp
6707 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6708 # with Tproxy version 4.
6709 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6710
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006711 backend transparent_http
6712 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6713 # proxy.
6714 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6715
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006716 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006717 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006719
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006720srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6721 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6723 yes | no | yes | yes
6724 Arguments :
6725 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6726 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6727 as explained at the top of this document.
6728
6729 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6730 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6731 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6732 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6733 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6734 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6735 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6736
6737 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6738 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6739 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6740 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6741 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006742 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006743 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006744 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006745
6746 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6747 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6748 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6749 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6750 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6751 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6752
6753 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6754 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6755
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006756 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6757 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006758
6759
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006760stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6761 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006763 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006764
6765 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6766 matched.
6767
6768 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6769 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6770
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006771 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6772 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6773 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6774
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006775 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6776 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6777 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6778 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006779
6780 Example :
6781 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6782 backend stats_localhost
6783 stats enable
6784 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6785
6786 Example :
6787 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6788 backend stats_auth
6789 stats enable
6790 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6791 stats admin if TRUE
6792
6793 Example :
6794 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6795 userlist stats-auth
6796 group admin users admin
6797 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6798 group readonly users haproxy
6799 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6800
6801 backend stats_auth
6802 stats enable
6803 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6804 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6805 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6806 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6807
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006808 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6809 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6810 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006811
6812
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006813stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6814 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006816 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006817 Arguments :
6818 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6819
6820 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6821
6822 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6823 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6824 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6825 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6826 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6827 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6828
6829 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6830 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6831 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006832 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006833
6834 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6835 report using "stats scope".
6836
6837 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6838 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6839 unobvious parameters.
6840
6841 Example :
6842 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6843 backend public_www
6844 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6845 stats enable
6846 stats hide-version
6847 stats scope .
6848 stats uri /admin?stats
6849 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6850 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6851 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6852
6853 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6854 backend private_monitoring
6855 stats enable
6856 stats uri /admin?stats
6857 stats refresh 5s
6858
6859 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6860
6861
6862stats enable
6863 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006865 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006866 Arguments : none
6867
6868 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6869 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6870 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6871 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6872 - stats auth : no authentication
6873 - stats scope : no restriction
6874
6875 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6876 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6877 unobvious parameters.
6878
6879 Example :
6880 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6881 backend public_www
6882 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6883 stats enable
6884 stats hide-version
6885 stats scope .
6886 stats uri /admin?stats
6887 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6888 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6889 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6890
6891 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6892 backend private_monitoring
6893 stats enable
6894 stats uri /admin?stats
6895 stats refresh 5s
6896
6897 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6898
6899
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006900stats hide-version
6901 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006903 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006904 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006905
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006906 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6907 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6908 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6909 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6910 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6911 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006913 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6914 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6915 unobvious parameters.
6916
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006917 Example :
6918 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6919 backend public_www
6920 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006921 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006922 stats hide-version
6923 stats scope .
6924 stats uri /admin?stats
6925 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6926 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6927 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006928
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006929 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6930 backend private_monitoring
6931 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006932 stats uri /admin?stats
6933 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006934
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006935 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006936
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006937
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006938stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6939 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6940 Access control for statistics
6941
6942 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6943 no | no | yes | yes
6944
6945 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6946 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6947 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6948 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6949 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6950 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6951
6952 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6953 instance.
6954
6955 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6956 about ACL usage.
6957
6958
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006959stats realm <realm>
6960 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006962 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006963 Arguments :
6964 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6965 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6966 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6967
6968 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6969 using a backslash ('\').
6970
6971 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6972 only related to authentication.
6973
6974 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6975 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6976 unobvious parameters.
6977
6978 Example :
6979 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6980 backend public_www
6981 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6982 stats enable
6983 stats hide-version
6984 stats scope .
6985 stats uri /admin?stats
6986 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6987 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6988 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6989
6990 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6991 backend private_monitoring
6992 stats enable
6993 stats uri /admin?stats
6994 stats refresh 5s
6995
6996 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6997
6998
6999stats refresh <delay>
7000 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007002 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007003 Arguments :
7004 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7005 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7006 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7007 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7008 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7009 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7010
7011 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7012 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7013 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7014 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7015
7016 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7017 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7018 unobvious parameters.
7019
7020 Example :
7021 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7022 backend public_www
7023 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7024 stats enable
7025 stats hide-version
7026 stats scope .
7027 stats uri /admin?stats
7028 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7029 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7030 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7031
7032 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7033 backend private_monitoring
7034 stats enable
7035 stats uri /admin?stats
7036 stats refresh 5s
7037
7038 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7039
7040
7041stats scope { <name> | "." }
7042 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007044 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007045 Arguments :
7046 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7047 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7048 section in which the statement appears.
7049
7050 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7051 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7052 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7053 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7054 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7055 exists.
7056
7057 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7058 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7059 unobvious parameters.
7060
7061 Example :
7062 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7063 backend public_www
7064 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7065 stats enable
7066 stats hide-version
7067 stats scope .
7068 stats uri /admin?stats
7069 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7070 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7071 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7072
7073 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7074 backend private_monitoring
7075 stats enable
7076 stats uri /admin?stats
7077 stats refresh 5s
7078
7079 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7080
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007081
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007082stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007083 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007085 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007086
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007087 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007088 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7089
7090 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7091 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7092
7093 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7094 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007095 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007096
7097 Example :
7098 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7099 backend private_monitoring
7100 stats enable
7101 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7102 stats uri /admin?stats
7103 stats refresh 5s
7104
7105 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7106 global section.
7107
7108
7109stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007110 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7112 yes | yes | yes | yes
7113 Arguments : none
7114
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007115 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007116 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7117 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7118 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7119 - IP (socket, server)
7120 - cookie (backend, server)
7121
7122 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7123 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007124 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007125
7126 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7127
7128
7129stats show-node [ <name> ]
7130 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007132 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007133 Arguments:
7134 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7135 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7136
7137 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7138 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007139 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007140
7141 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7142 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7143 unobvious parameters.
7144
7145 Example:
7146 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7147 backend private_monitoring
7148 stats enable
7149 stats show-node Europe-1
7150 stats uri /admin?stats
7151 stats refresh 5s
7152
7153 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7154 section.
7155
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007156
7157stats uri <prefix>
7158 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007160 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007161 Arguments :
7162 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7163 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7164 query string.
7165
7166 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7167 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7168 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7169 possible to reach it in the application.
7170
7171 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007172 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007173 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7174 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7175 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7176 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7177
7178 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7179 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7180 an address or a port to statistics only.
7181
7182 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7183 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7184 unobvious parameters.
7185
7186 Example :
7187 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7188 backend public_www
7189 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7190 stats enable
7191 stats hide-version
7192 stats scope .
7193 stats uri /admin?stats
7194 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7195 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7196 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7197
7198 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7199 backend private_monitoring
7200 stats enable
7201 stats uri /admin?stats
7202 stats refresh 5s
7203
7204 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7205
7206
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007207stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7208 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007210 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007211
7212 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007213 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007214 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7215 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7216 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7217
7218 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7219 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7220 the "stick-table" statement.
7221
7222 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7223 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7224 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7225 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7226 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7227
7228 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7229 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7230 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7231 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7232 transformation rules.
7233
7234 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7235 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7236 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7237 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7238 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7239 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7240 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7241
7242 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7243 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7244 ACL based conditions.
7245
7246 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7247 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7248 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7249 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7250
7251 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7252 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7253 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7254 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7255
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007256 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7257 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7258 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7259
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007260 Example :
7261 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7262 # last 30 minutes
7263 backend pop
7264 mode tcp
7265 balance roundrobin
7266 stick store-request src
7267 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7268 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7269 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7270
7271 backend smtp
7272 mode tcp
7273 balance roundrobin
7274 stick match src table pop
7275 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7276 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7277
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007278 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007279 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007280
7281
7282stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7283 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7285 no | no | yes | yes
7286
7287 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7288 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7289 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7290 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7291
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007292 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7293 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7294 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7295
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007296 Examples :
7297 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007298 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007299
7300 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7301 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7302 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7303
7304
7305 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7306 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7307 backend http
7308 mode http
7309 balance roundrobin
7310 stick on src table https
7311 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7312 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7313 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7314
7315 backend https
7316 mode tcp
7317 balance roundrobin
7318 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7319 stick on src
7320 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7321 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7322
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007323 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007324
7325
7326stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7327 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7329 no | no | yes | yes
7330
7331 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007332 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007333 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7334 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7335 server is selected.
7336
7337 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7338 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7339 the "stick-table" statement.
7340
7341 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7342 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7343 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7344 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7345 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7346 address.
7347
7348 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7349 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7350 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7351 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7352 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7353 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7354 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7355 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7356 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7357 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7358
7359 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7360 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7361 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7362 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7363 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7364 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7365 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7366
7367 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7368 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7369 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7370 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7371
7372 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7373 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7374 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7375 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7376 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7377 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007378 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7379 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7380 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7381 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7382 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7383 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007384
7385 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7386 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7387 the request.
7388
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007389 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7390 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7391 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7392
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007393 Example :
7394 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7395 # last 30 minutes
7396 backend pop
7397 mode tcp
7398 balance roundrobin
7399 stick store-request src
7400 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7401 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7402 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7403
7404 backend smtp
7405 mode tcp
7406 balance roundrobin
7407 stick match src table pop
7408 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7409 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7410
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007411 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007412 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007413
7414
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007415stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007416 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7417 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007418 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007420 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007421
7422 Arguments :
7423 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7424 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7425 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7426 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7427
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007428 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7429 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7430 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7431 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7432
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007433 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7434 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7435 instance.
7436
7437 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7438 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7439 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7440 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7441 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7442 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007443 to 32 characters.
7444
7445 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7446 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7447 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007448 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007449 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7450 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007451
7452 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007453 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7454 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007455 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7456 increase.
7457
7458 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007459 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7460 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7461 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007462
7463 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7464 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7465 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7466 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7467 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7468 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7469 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7470 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7471 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7472 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7473 parameter (see below).
7474
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007475 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7476 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7477 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7478 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7479 soft restart.
7480
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02007481 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
7482 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007483
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007484 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7485 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7486 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7487 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7488 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007489 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007490 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7491 if not expiration delay is specified.
7492
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007493 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7494 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7495 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7496 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007497 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7498 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7499 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7500 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7501 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7502 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7503 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7504 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7505 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7506 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7507 types and their arguments.
7508
7509 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7510 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7511 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7512 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7513
7514 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7515 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7516 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7517 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7518
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007519 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7520 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7521 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7522 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7523 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7524 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7525
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007526 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7527 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7528 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7529 they were received.
7530
7531 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7532 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7533 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7534 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7535 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7536
7537 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7538 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7539 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7540 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7541 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7542
7543 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7544 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7545 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7546
7547 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7548 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7549 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7550 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7551 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7552
7553 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7554 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7555 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7556 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7557 the client side.
7558
7559 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7560 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7561 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7562 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7563 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7564 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7565 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7566
7567 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7568 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7569 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7570 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7571 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7572 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7573 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7574
7575 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7576 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7577 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7578 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7579 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7580 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7581
7582 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7583 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7584 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7585 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7586
7587 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7588 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7589 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7590 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7591 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7592 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7593 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7594 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7595 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7596 recommended for better fairness.
7597
7598 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7599 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7600 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7601 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7602
7603 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7604 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7605 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7606 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7607 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7608 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7609 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7610 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7611 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7612 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007613
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007614 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7615 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007616 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7617 reference it.
7618
7619 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7620 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7621 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7622 as an exclusive stickiness.
7623
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007624 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7625 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7626 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7627 something that can be ignored.
7628
7629 Example:
7630 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7631 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7632 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7633 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7634
7635 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007636 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007637
7638
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007639stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7640 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7642 no | no | yes | yes
7643
7644 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007645 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007646 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7647 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7648 server is selected.
7649
7650 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7651 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7652 the "stick-table" statement.
7653
7654 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7655 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7656 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7657 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7658
7659 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7660 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7661 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7662 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7663 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7664 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007665 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007666 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7667 rules.
7668
7669 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7670 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7671 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7672 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7673 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7674 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7675 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7676
7677 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7678 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7679 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7680 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7681
7682 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7683 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7684 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7685 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7686 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7687 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007688 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7689 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7690 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7691 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7692 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7693 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7694 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7695 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7696 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007697
7698 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7699
7700 Example :
7701 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7702 backend https
7703 mode tcp
7704 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007705 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007706 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007707
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007708 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7709 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7710
7711 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7712 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7713 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7714
7715 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7716 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007717
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007718 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7719 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7720 # at offset 44.
7721
7722 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7723 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7724
7725 # Learn on response if server hello.
7726 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007727
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007728 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7729 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7730
7731 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7732 extraction.
7733
7734
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007735tcp-check connect [params*]
7736 Opens a new connection
7737 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7738 no | no | yes | yes
7739
7740 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7741 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7742 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7743
7744 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7745 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7746 of the sequence.
7747
7748 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7749 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7750 do.
7751
7752 Parameters :
7753 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7754 use the TCP connection.
7755
7756 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7757 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7758 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7759
7760 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7761
7762 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7763
7764 Examples:
7765 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7766 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7767 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7768 option tcp-check
7769 tcp-check connect
7770 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7771 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7772 tcp-check send \r\n
7773 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7774 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7775 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7776 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7777 tcp-check send \r\n
7778 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7779 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7780
7781 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7782 option tcp-check
7783 tcp-check connect port 110
7784 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7785 tcp-check connect port 143
7786 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7787 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7788
7789 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7790
7791
7792tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7793 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7795 no | no | yes | yes
7796
7797 Arguments :
7798 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7799 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7800 binary.
7801 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7802 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7803 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7804
7805 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7806 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7807 with the usual backslash ('\').
7808 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7809 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7810 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7811 used upper or lower case.
7812
7813
7814 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7815
7816 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7817 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7818 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7819 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7820 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7821 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7822 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7823 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7824
7825 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7826 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7827 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7828 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7829 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7830 expression.
7831
7832 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7833 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7834 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7835 this exact hexadecimal string.
7836 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7837
7838 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7839 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7840 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7841 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7842 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7843 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7844 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7845 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7846 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7847 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7848 the null character.
7849
7850 Examples :
7851 # perform a POP check
7852 option tcp-check
7853 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7854
7855 # perform an IMAP check
7856 option tcp-check
7857 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7858
7859 # look for the redis master server
7860 option tcp-check
7861 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7862 tcp-check expect +PONG
7863 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7864 tcp-check expect string role:master
7865 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7866 tcp-check expect string +OK
7867
7868
7869 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7870 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7871
7872
7873tcp-check send <data>
7874 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7875 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7876 no | no | yes | yes
7877
7878 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7879 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7880
7881 Examples :
7882 # look for the redis master server
7883 option tcp-check
7884 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7885 tcp-check expect string role:master
7886
7887 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7888 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7889
7890
7891tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7892 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7893 tcp health check
7894 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7895 no | no | yes | yes
7896
7897 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7898 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7899 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7900 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7901 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7902 hexadecimal string.
7903 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7904
7905 Examples :
7906 # redis check in binary
7907 option tcp-check
7908 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7909 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7910
7911
7912 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7913 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7914
7915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007916tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7917 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7919 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007920 Arguments :
7921 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007922 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7923 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007924
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007925 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007926
7927 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7928 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007929 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7930 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7931 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7932 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7933 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7934 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007935
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007936 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7937 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7938 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7939 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007940
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007941 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007942 - accept :
7943 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7944 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7945 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007946
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007947 - reject :
7948 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7949 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7950 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7951 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7952 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7953 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7954 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7955 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7956 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7957 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7958 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7959 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007960
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007961 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7962 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7963 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7964 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7965 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7966 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7967 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7968 hosts.
7969
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007970 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7971 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7972 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7973 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7974 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7975 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7976 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7977 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7978 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007979 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
7980 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007981
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007982 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007983 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007984 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007985 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007986 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7987 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007988 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007989 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7990 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7991 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7992 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7993 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007994
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007995 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007996 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007997 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007998 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7999 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8000 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8001 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008002
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008003 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8004 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8005 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8006 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008007
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008008 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8009 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8010 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8011 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8012 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008013 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8014 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8015 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8016 layer7 information is extracted.
8017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008018 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8019 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8020 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8021 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8022 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008023
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008024 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8025 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8026 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008028 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8029 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8030 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008031
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008032 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008033 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008034 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008035
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008036 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8037 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8038 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008039
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008040 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008041 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8042 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008043
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008044 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8045
8046 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8047
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008048 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8049
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008050 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008051
8052
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008053tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8054 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008056 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008057 Arguments :
8058 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008059 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008060 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
8061 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008062
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008063 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008064
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008065 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8066 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8067 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8068 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8069 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008070
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008071 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8072 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8073 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8074 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008075 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8076 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8077 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8078 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8079 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8080 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008081 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008082 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008083
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008084 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8085 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8086 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8087 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008088
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008089 Four types of actions are supported :
8090 - accept : the request is accepted
8091 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8092 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008093 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008094
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008095 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8096 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008097
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008098 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8099 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8100 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8101 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8102 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8103 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008105 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008106 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8107 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008108
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008109 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008110 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8111 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8112 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8113 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008114 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8115 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8116 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008117
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008118 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008119 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8120 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8121 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008122
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008123 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8124 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8125 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8126 documentation.
8127
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008128 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008129 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8130 # and reject everything else.
8131 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8132 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008133 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008134 tcp-request content reject
8135
8136 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008137 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8138 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8139 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008140 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008141
8142 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8143 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8144 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008145 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008146 tcp-request content reject
8147
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008148 Example:
8149 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8150 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008151 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008152
8153 Example:
8154 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8155 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008156 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008157
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008158 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8159 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8160
8161 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008162 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008163 # protecting all our sites
8164 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008165 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8166 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008167 ...
8168 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8169
8170 backend http_dynamic
8171 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008172 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008173 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008174 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8175 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8176 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008177 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008179 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008180
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008181 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008182
8183
8184tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8185 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008187 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008188 Arguments :
8189 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8190 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8191 as explained at the top of this document.
8192
8193 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8194 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8195 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8196 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8197 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8198
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008199 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8200 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8201 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8202 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8203
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008204 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8205 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008206 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008207 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008208 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8209 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8210 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8211 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008212
8213 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8214 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8215 it pass through unaffected.
8216
8217 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8218 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8219 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008220 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008221 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8222 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008223 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8224 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8225 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008226
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008227 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008228 "timeout client".
8229
8230
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008231tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8232 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8234 no | no | yes | yes
8235 Arguments :
8236 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008237 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008238
8239 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8240
8241 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8242 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8243 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008244 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8245 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008246
8247 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8248
8249 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8250 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8251 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8252 inserted.
8253
8254 Two types of actions are supported :
8255 - accept :
8256 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8257 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8258 the rules evaluation.
8259
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008260 - close :
8261 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8262 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8263 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8264 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8265 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8266 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008267 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008268 protocols.
8269
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008270 - reject :
8271 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8272 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008273 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008274
8275 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8276 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8277 for changing the default action to a reject.
8278
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008279 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8280 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8281 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8282 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008283 period.
8284
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008285 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8286 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8287 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8288 documentation.
8289
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008290 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8291
8292 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8293
8294
8295tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8296 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8298 no | no | yes | yes
8299 Arguments :
8300 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8301 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8302 as explained at the top of this document.
8303
8304 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8305
8306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008307timeout check <timeout>
8308 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8309 established.
8310
8311 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8312 yes | no | yes | yes
8313 Arguments:
8314 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8315 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8316 as explained at the top of this document.
8317
8318 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8319 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8320 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8321 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008322 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8323 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8324 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008325
8326 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8327 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8328
8329 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8330 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008331 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008332
8333 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8334 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8335 forget about it.
8336
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008337 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8338 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008339
8340
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008341timeout client <timeout>
8342timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8343 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8345 yes | yes | yes | no
8346 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008347 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008348 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8349 as explained at the top of this document.
8350
8351 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8352 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8353 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8354 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8355 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8356 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8357 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8358 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008359 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008360 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008361 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8362 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008363 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8364 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008365
8366 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8367 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8368 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8369 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8370 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8371 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8372
8373 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8374 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8375 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8376
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008377 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008378
8379
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008380timeout client-fin <timeout>
8381 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8383 yes | yes | yes | no
8384 Arguments :
8385 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8386 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8387 as explained at the top of this document.
8388
8389 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8390 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8391 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8392 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8393 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8394 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8395 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8396 down in one direction.
8397
8398 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8399 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8400 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8401
8402 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8403
8404
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008405timeout connect <timeout>
8406timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8407 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8409 yes | no | yes | yes
8410 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008411 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008412 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8413 as explained at the top of this document.
8414
8415 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008416 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008417 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008418 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008419 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8420 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008421
8422 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8423 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8424 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8425 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8426 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8427 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8428
8429 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8430 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8431 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8432
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008433 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8434 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008435
8436
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008437timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8438 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8440 yes | yes | yes | yes
8441 Arguments :
8442 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8443 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8444 as explained at the top of this document.
8445
8446 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8447 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8448 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8449 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8450 once the request has started to present itself.
8451
8452 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8453 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8454 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8455 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8456 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8457
8458 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8459 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8460 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8461 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8462
8463 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8464 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8465 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8466 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8467 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008468 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008469
8470 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8471 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8472 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8473 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8474
8475 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8476
8477
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008478timeout http-request <timeout>
8479 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008481 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008482 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008483 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008484 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8485 as explained at the top of this document.
8486
8487 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8488 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8489 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8490 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8491 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8492 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8493 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008494 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8495 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8496 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8497 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8498 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008499 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
8500 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008501
8502 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8503 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008504 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8505 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008506
8507 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8508 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8509 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8510 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8511 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8512
8513 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008514 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8515 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8516 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008517
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008518 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
8519 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008520
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008521
8522timeout queue <timeout>
8523 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8525 yes | no | yes | yes
8526 Arguments :
8527 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8528 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8529 as explained at the top of this document.
8530
8531 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8532 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8533 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8534 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8535 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8536
8537 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8538 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8539 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8540 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8541
8542 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8543
8544
8545timeout server <timeout>
8546timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8547 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8549 yes | no | yes | yes
8550 Arguments :
8551 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8552 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8553 as explained at the top of this document.
8554
8555 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8556 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8557 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8558 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8559 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8560 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8561 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8562
8563 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8564 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8565 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8566 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8567 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008568 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008569 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008570 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8571 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8572 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8573 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008574
8575 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8576 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8577 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8578 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8579 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8580 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8581
8582 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8583 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8584 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8585
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008586 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008587
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008588
8589timeout server-fin <timeout>
8590 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8592 yes | no | yes | yes
8593 Arguments :
8594 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8595 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8596 as explained at the top of this document.
8597
8598 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8599 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8600 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8601 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8602 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8603 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8604 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8605 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8606 situations, it should not be needed.
8607
8608 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8609 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8610 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8611
8612 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8613
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008614
8615timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008616 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8618 yes | yes | yes | yes
8619 Arguments :
8620 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8621 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8622 as explained at the top of this document.
8623
8624 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8625 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8626 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8627
8628 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8629 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8630 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8631 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008632 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008633
8634 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8635
8636
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008637timeout tunnel <timeout>
8638 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8640 yes | no | yes | yes
8641 Arguments :
8642 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8643 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8644 as explained at the top of this document.
8645
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008646 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008647 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8648 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8649 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8650 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8651 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8652 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8653 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8654 specified.
8655
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008656 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8657 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8658 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8659 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8660 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8661 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8662 state.
8663
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008664 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8665 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8666 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8667 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8668 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8669
8670 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8671 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8672 forget about it.
8673
8674 Example :
8675 defaults http
8676 option http-server-close
8677 timeout connect 5s
8678 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008679 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008680 timeout server 30s
8681 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8682
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008683 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008684
8685
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008686transparent (deprecated)
8687 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008689 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008690 Arguments : none
8691
8692 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8693 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8694 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8695 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8696 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8697 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8698 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8699 appropriate server.
8700
8701 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8702
8703 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8704 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8705
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008706 See also: "option transparent"
8707
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008708unique-id-format <string>
8709 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8711 yes | yes | yes | no
8712 Arguments :
8713 <string> is a log-format string.
8714
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008715 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8716 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8717 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8718 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008719
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008720 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8721 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8722 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8723 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8724 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8725 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8726 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8727 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008728
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008729 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8730 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008731
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008732 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008733
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008734 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008735
8736 will generate:
8737
8738 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8739
8740 See also: "unique-id-header"
8741
8742unique-id-header <name>
8743 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8745 yes | yes | yes | no
8746 Arguments :
8747 <name> is the name of the header.
8748
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008749 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8750 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008751
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008752 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008753
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008754 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008755 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8756
8757 will generate:
8758
8759 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8760
8761 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008762
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008763use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008764 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8766 no | yes | yes | no
8767 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008768 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8769 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008770
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008771 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8772 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008773
8774 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8775 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8776 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008777 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8778 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8779 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8780 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008781
8782 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8783 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8784 assign the backend.
8785
8786 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8787 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8788 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8789 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8790 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8791 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8792
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008793 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008794 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008795 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8796 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8797 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8798
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008799 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8800 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8801 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8802 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8803 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8804 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8805 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8806 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8807 cannot be forced from the request.
8808
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008809 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008810 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8811 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8812
8813 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8814 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008815
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008816
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008817use-server <server> if <condition>
8818use-server <server> unless <condition>
8819 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8821 no | no | yes | yes
8822 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008823 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008824
8825 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8826
8827 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8828 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8829 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8830
8831 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8832 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8833 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8834 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8835 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8836 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8837 matches will assign the server.
8838
8839 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8840 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8841 with the next rules until one matches.
8842
8843 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8844 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8845 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8846 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8847
8848 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8849 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8850 stripped.
8851
8852 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8853 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8854 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8855 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8856
8857 Example :
8858 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8859 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8860 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8861 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8862 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8863 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8864 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8865 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8866 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8867
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008868 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008869
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008870
88715. Bind and Server options
8872--------------------------
8873
8874The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8875depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8876settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8877written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8878described in this section.
8879
8880
88815.1. Bind options
8882-----------------
8883
8884The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8885as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8886no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8887parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8888while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8889provided immediately after the setting name.
8890
8891The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8892
8893accept-proxy
8894 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008895 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8896 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008897 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8898 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8899 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8900 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8901 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8902 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8903 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008904 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8905 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008906
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008907alpn <protocols>
8908 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8909 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8910 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8911 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8912 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8913 initial NPN extension.
8914
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008915backlog <backlog>
8916 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8917 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8918
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008919ecdhe <named curve>
8920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008921 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8922 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008923
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008924ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008925 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8926 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8927 client's certificate.
8928
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008929ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8930 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8931 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8932 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8933 error is ignored.
8934
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008935ciphers <ciphers>
8936 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8937 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008938 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008939 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8940 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8941
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008942crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008943 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8944 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8945 to verify client's certificate.
8946
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008947crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008948 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8949 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8950 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8951 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8952 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8953 file.
8954
8955 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8956 are loaded.
8957
8958 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008959 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01008960 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
8961 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
8962 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
8963 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
8964 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
8965 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
8966 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008967
8968 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8969 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8970 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8971 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008972 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
8973 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008974
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008975 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008976
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008977 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8978 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008979 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008980 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8981 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8982 clients).
8983
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008984 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8985 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8986 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8987 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8988 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8989 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8990 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8991 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8992 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8993 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8994 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8995 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8996 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8997
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01008998 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
8999 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9000 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9001 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9002 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9003
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009004crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009005 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9006 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009007 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009008 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009009
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009010crt-list <file>
9011 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009012 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9013 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009014
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009015 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009016
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009017 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9018 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9019 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9020 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9021 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9022 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9023 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9024 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009025
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009026defer-accept
9027 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9028 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9029 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9030 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9031 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9032 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9033 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9034 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9035 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9036 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9037 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9038
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009039force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009040 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009041 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009042 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9043 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009044
9045force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009046 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009047 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9048 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009049
9050force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009051 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009052 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9053 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009054
9055force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009056 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009057 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9058 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009059
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009060gid <gid>
9061 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9062 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9063 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9064 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9065 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9066
9067group <group>
9068 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9069 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9070 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9071 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9072 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9073
9074id <id>
9075 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9076 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9077 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9078 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9079
9080interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009081 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9082 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9083 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9084 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9085 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9086 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9087 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009088
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009089level <level>
9090 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9091 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9092 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9093 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9094 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9095 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9096 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9097 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9098 counters).
9099 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9100 all counters).
9101
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009102maxconn <maxconn>
9103 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9104 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9105 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9106 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9107 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9108 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9109 eat all memory.
9110
9111mode <mode>
9112 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9113 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9114 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9115 UNIX sockets.
9116
9117mss <maxseg>
9118 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9119 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9120 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9121 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9122 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9123 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9124 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9125 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9126 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9127 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9128 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9129
9130name <name>
9131 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9132 page.
9133
9134nice <nice>
9135 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9136 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9137 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9138 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9139 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9140 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9141 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9142 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9143 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9144 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9145 one for an RDP socket.
9146
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009147no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009148 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009149 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009150 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009151 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9152 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009153 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009154
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009155no-tls-tickets
9156 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9157 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9158 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009159 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9160 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009161
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009162no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009163 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009164 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009165 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009166 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9167 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9168 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009169
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009170no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009171 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009172 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009173 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009174 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9175 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9176 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009177
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009178no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009180 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009181 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009182 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9183 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9184 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009185
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009186npn <protocols>
9187 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9188 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9189 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9190 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009191 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9192 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009193
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009194process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9195 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9196 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9197 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9198 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9199 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9200 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9201 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009202 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9203 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9204 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9205 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9206 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9207 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9208 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009209
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009210ssl
9211 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009212 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009213 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9214 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9215 to deciphered contents.
9216
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009217strict-sni
9218 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9219 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9220 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9221 See the "crt" option for more information.
9222
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009223tcp-ut <delay>
9224 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9225 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9226 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9227 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9228 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9229 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9230 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9231 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9232 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9233 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9234 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9235
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009236tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009237 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009238 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9239 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9240 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9241 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9242 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9243 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9244 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009245 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9246 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9247 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009248
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009249tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9250 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9251 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9252 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9253 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9254 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9255 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9256 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9257 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9258 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9259 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9260
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009261transparent
9262 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9263 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9264 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9265 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9266 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9267 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9268 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9269 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9270 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9271 so check for support with your vendor.
9272
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009273v4v6
9274 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9275 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9276 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9277 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009278 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009279
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009280v6only
9281 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9282 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9283 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009284 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9285 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009286
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009287uid <uid>
9288 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9289 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9290 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9291 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9292 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9293
9294user <user>
9295 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9296 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9297 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9298 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9299 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9300
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009301verify [none|optional|required]
9302 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9303 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9304 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9305 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9306 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009307 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9308 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9309 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9310 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009311
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020093125.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009313------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009314
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009315The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9316which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9317arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9318settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9319after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9320Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9321address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009323 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009324 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009326The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009327
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009328addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009329 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9330 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9331 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9332 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9333 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009334
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009335 Supported in default-server: No
9336
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009337agent-check
9338 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009339 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9340 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9341 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9342 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009343
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009344 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009345 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009346 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9347 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9348 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009349
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009350 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9351 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009352
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009353 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9354 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9355 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009356
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009357 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9358 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9359 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009360
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009361 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9362 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9363 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9364 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9365 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9366 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9367 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009368
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009369 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9370 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009371
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009372 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9373 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9374 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9375 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9376 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9377 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9378 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9379 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9380 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009381
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009382 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9383 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009384 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9385 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9386 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9387 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009388
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009389 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9390 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009391
9392 Supported in default-server: No
9393
9394agent-inter <delay>
9395 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9396 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9397
9398 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9399 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9400 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9401 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9402 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9403 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9404 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9405 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9406 of backends use the same servers.
9407
9408 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9409
9410 Supported in default-server: Yes
9411
9412agent-port <port>
9413 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9414
9415 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9416
9417 Supported in default-server: Yes
9418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009419backup
9420 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9421 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9422 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9423 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9424 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9425 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009426
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009427 Supported in default-server: No
9428
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009429ca-file <cafile>
9430 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9431 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9432 server's certificate.
9433
9434 Supported in default-server: No
9435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009436check
9437 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009438 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9439 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9440 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9441 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9442 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9443 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9444 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009445 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9446 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9447 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009448
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009449 Supported in default-server: No
9450
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009451check-send-proxy
9452 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9453 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9454 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9455 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9456 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9457 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9458 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9459
9460 Supported in default-server: No
9461
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009462check-ssl
9463 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9464 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9465 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9466 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009467 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009468 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9469 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9470 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9471 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9472
9473 Supported in default-server: No
9474
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009475ciphers <ciphers>
9476 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009477 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009478 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9479 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9480 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9481 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9482 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9483 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9484
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009485 Supported in default-server: No
9486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009487cookie <value>
9488 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9489 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9490 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9491 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9492 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9493 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9494 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9495
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009496 Supported in default-server: No
9497
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009498crl-file <crlfile>
9499 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9500 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9501 to verify server's certificate.
9502
9503 Supported in default-server: No
9504
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009505crt <cert>
9506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9507 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9508 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9509 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9510 certificate request.
9511
9512 Supported in default-server: No
9513
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009514disabled
9515 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9516 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9517 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9518 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9519 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9520
9521 Supported in default-server: No
9522
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009523error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009524 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9525 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9526 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009527
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009528 Supported in default-server: Yes
9529
9530 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009531
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009532fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009533 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9534 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9535 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009537 Supported in default-server: Yes
9538
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009539force-sslv3
9540 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9541 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009542 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9543 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009544
9545 Supported in default-server: No
9546
9547force-tlsv10
9548 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009549 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9550 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009551
9552 Supported in default-server: No
9553
9554force-tlsv11
9555 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009556 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9557 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009558
9559 Supported in default-server: No
9560
9561force-tlsv12
9562 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009563 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9564 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009565
9566 Supported in default-server: No
9567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009568id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009569 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9570 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9571 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009573 Supported in default-server: No
9574
9575inter <delay>
9576fastinter <delay>
9577downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009578 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9579 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9580 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9581 between checks depending on the server state :
9582
9583 Server state | Interval used
9584 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9585 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9586 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9587 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9588 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9589 or yet unchecked. |
9590 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9591 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9592 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009593
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009594 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9595 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9596 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9597 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009598 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9599 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9600 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9601 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9602 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009604 Supported in default-server: Yes
9605
9606maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009607 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9608 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9609 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9610 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9611 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9612 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9613 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9614 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009616 Supported in default-server: Yes
9617
9618maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009619 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9620 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9621 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9622 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9623 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9624 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9625 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009627 Supported in default-server: Yes
9628
9629minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009630 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9631 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9632 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9633 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9634 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9635 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009636 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009637 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009638
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009639 Supported in default-server: Yes
9640
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009641no-ssl-reuse
9642 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9643 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9644 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9645 and for paranoid users.
9646
9647 Supported in default-server: No
9648
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009649no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009650 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9651 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009652 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009653
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009654 Supported in default-server: No
9655
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009656no-tls-tickets
9657 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9658 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9659 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009660 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9661 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009662
9663 Supported in default-server: No
9664
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009665no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009666 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009667 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9668 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009669 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9670 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9671 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009672
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009673 Supported in default-server: No
9674
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009675no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009676 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009677 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9678 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009679 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9680 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9681 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009682
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009683 Supported in default-server: No
9684
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009685no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009686 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009687 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9688 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009689 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9690 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9691 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009692
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009693 Supported in default-server: No
9694
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009695non-stick
9696 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9697 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9698 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9699
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009700 Supported in default-server: No
9701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009702observe <mode>
9703 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9704 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9705 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9706 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9707 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9708 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009709 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009710
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009711 Supported in default-server: No
9712
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009713 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009715on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009716 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9717 Currently, four modes are available:
9718 - fastinter: force fastinter
9719 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9720 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9721 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9722 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9723
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009724 Supported in default-server: Yes
9725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009726 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9727
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009728on-marked-down <action>
9729 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9730 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009731 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9732 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9733 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9734 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9735 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9736 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9737 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9738 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009739
9740 Actions are disabled by default
9741
9742 Supported in default-server: Yes
9743
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009744on-marked-up <action>
9745 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9746 Currently one action is available:
9747 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9748 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9749 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9750 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9751 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9752 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9753 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9754 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9755
9756 Actions are disabled by default
9757
9758 Supported in default-server: Yes
9759
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009760port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009761 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9762 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9763 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9764 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9765 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9766 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9767
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009768 Supported in default-server: Yes
9769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009770redir <prefix>
9771 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9772 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9773 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9774 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9775 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9776 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9777 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9778 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009779 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009780 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9781 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9782 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9783 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9784 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9785
9786 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9787
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009788 Supported in default-server: No
9789
9790rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009791 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9792 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9793 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009795 Supported in default-server: Yes
9796
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009797send-proxy
9798 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9799 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9800 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9801 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9802 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9803 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9804 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9805 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9806 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009807 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9808 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9809 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9810 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9811 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009812
9813 Supported in default-server: No
9814
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009815send-proxy-v2
9816 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9817 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9818 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9819 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9820 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9821 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9822 option of the "bind" keyword.
9823
9824 Supported in default-server: No
9825
9826send-proxy-v2-ssl
9827 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9828 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9829 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9830 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9831 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9832 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9833 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9834 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9835
9836 Supported in default-server: No
9837
9838send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9839 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9840 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9841 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9842 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9843 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9844 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9845 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9846 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9847 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9848
9849 Supported in default-server: No
9850
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009851slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009852 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9853 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9854 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9855 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9856 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9857 parameters :
9858
9859 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9860 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9861
9862 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9863 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9864 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9865 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9866
9867 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9868 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9869 seen as failed.
9870
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009871 Supported in default-server: Yes
9872
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009873source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009874source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009875source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009876 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9877 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9878 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9879 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9880
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009881 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9882 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9883 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9884 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9885 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9886 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9887 server.
9888
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009889 Supported in default-server: No
9890
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009891ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009892 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9893 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9894 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9895 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9896 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9897 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009898 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009899
9900 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009902track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009903 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9904 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9905 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9906 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009907 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9908
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009909 Supported in default-server: No
9910
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009911verify [none|required]
9912 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009913 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9914 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9915 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9916 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009917 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9918 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9919 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009920
9921 Supported in default-server: No
9922
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009923verifyhost <hostname>
9924 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9925 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9926 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9927 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9928 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9929 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9930
9931 Supported in default-server: No
9932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009933weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009934 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9935 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9936 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009937 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9938 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9939 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9940 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9941 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9942 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009944 Supported in default-server: Yes
9945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009946
99476. HTTP header manipulation
9948---------------------------
9949
9950In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9951response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9952request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9953which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009954against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009955
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009956If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9957to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9958but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9959HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9960stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9961because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9962a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9963still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009964
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009965This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9966in section 4.2 :
9967
9968 - reqadd <string>
9969 - reqallow <search>
9970 - reqiallow <search>
9971 - reqdel <search>
9972 - reqidel <search>
9973 - reqdeny <search>
9974 - reqideny <search>
9975 - reqpass <search>
9976 - reqipass <search>
9977 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9978 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9979 - reqtarpit <search>
9980 - reqitarpit <search>
9981 - rspadd <string>
9982 - rspdel <search>
9983 - rspidel <search>
9984 - rspdeny <search>
9985 - rspideny <search>
9986 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9987 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9988
9989With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9990is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9991parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9992prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9993Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9994
9995 \t for a tab
9996 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9997 \n for a new line (LF)
9998 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9999 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
10000 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
10001 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
10002 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
10003
10004The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
10005portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
10006above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
10007regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
100089 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
10009is very common to users of the "sed" program.
10010
10011The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
10012after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
10013
10014Notes related to these keywords :
10015---------------------------------
10016 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
10017 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
10018 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
10019
10020 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
10021 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
10022 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
10023
10024 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
10025 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
10026 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
10027 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
10028 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
10029
10030 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
10031 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
10032 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
10033 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
10034 useless headers before adding new ones.
10035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010036 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010037 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
10038
10039 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
10040 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
10041 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
10042
10043 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
10044 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010045 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010046
10047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200100487. Using ACLs and fetching samples
10049----------------------------------
10050
10051Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
10052client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
10053The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
10054these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
10055but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
10056data called patterns.
10057
10058
100597.1. ACL basics
10060---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010061
10062The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
10063content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
10064from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
10065simple :
10066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010067 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010068 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010069 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
10070 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010072The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
10073adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010074
10075In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
10076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010077 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010078
10079This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
10080Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
10081and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010082an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
10083conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
10084as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
10085are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010086
10087ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
10088'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
10089which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
10090
10091There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
10092performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
10093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010094The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
10095specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
10096this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010097methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
10098ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010099
10100Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
10101 - boolean
10102 - integer (signed or unsigned)
10103 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
10104 - string
10105 - data block
10106
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010107Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
10108converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
10109would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
10110The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
10111which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
10112
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010113Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
10114keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10115fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10116which are summarized in the table below :
10117
10118 +---------------------+-----------------+
10119 | Sample or converter | Default |
10120 | output type | matching method |
10121 +---------------------+-----------------+
10122 | boolean | bool |
10123 +---------------------+-----------------+
10124 | integer | int |
10125 +---------------------+-----------------+
10126 | ip | ip |
10127 +---------------------+-----------------+
10128 | string | str |
10129 +---------------------+-----------------+
10130 | binary | none, use "-m" |
10131 +---------------------+-----------------+
10132
10133Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
10134matching method, see below.
10135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010136The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
10137 - boolean
10138 - integer or integer range
10139 - IP address / network
10140 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
10141 - regular expression
10142 - hex block
10143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010144The following ACL flags are currently supported :
10145
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010146 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
10147 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010148 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010149 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010150 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010151 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010152 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
10153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010154The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
10155read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
10156if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
10157lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
10158will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
10159beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
10160a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
10161lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
10162exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
10163
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010164The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
10165parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
10166ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
10167a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
10168check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
10169
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010170The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
10171socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
10172file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
10173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010174Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
10175loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
10176
10177 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
10178
10179In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
10180the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
10181case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
10182as well.
10183
10184The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
10185sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
10186do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
10187methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
10188is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
10189obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
10190followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
10191default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
10192that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
10193string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
10194
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010195The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
10196By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10197string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10198resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10199server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10200waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10201flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10202function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010204There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10205sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10206be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010207
10208 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10209 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010210 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10211 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10212 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10213 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010214
10215 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10216 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010217 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010218
10219 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010220 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010221
10222 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010223 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010224
10225 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10226 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10227
10228 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10229 binary or string samples.
10230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010231 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10232 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010234 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10235 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10236 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010238 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10239 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010241 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10242 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010244 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10245 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010247 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10248 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010249 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010251 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10252 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10253 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010254
10255For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10256request, it is possible to do :
10257
10258 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10259
10260In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10261buffer, one would use the following acl :
10262
10263 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10264
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010265On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10266possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10267
10268 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010270All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10271criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10272method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10273to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10274criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10275the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010277If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010278the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10279For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010281 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10282 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10283 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10284 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010285
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010286
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010287The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10288types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10289combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10290brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10291default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010293 +-------------------------------------------------+
10294 | Input sample type |
10295 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010296 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010297 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10298 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10299 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010300 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010301 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010302 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010303 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010304 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010305 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010306 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010307 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010308 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010309 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010310 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010311 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010312 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010313 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010314 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010315 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010316 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010317 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010318 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010319 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010320 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010321 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10322 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10323 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010324
10325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103267.1.1. Matching booleans
10327------------------------
10328
10329In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10330Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10331When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10332that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10333
10334Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10335return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10336"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10337
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103397.1.2. Matching integers
10340------------------------
10341
10342Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10343enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10344to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10345
10346Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10347matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10348lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010349
10350For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10351unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10352representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10353
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010354As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10355two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10356instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10357ranges and operators.
10358
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010359For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010360operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10361Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10362of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010364Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010365
10366 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10367 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10368 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10369 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10370 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010372For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010373
10374 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10375
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010376This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10377
10378 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10379
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103817.1.3. Matching strings
10382-----------------------
10383
10384String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10385different forms :
10386
10387 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10388 patterns ;
10389
10390 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10391 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10392
10393 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10394 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10395
10396 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10397 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10398
10399 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10400 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10401 matches.
10402
10403 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10404 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10405 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010406
10407String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10408exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10409characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10410string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10411to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010412before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010413
10414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104157.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10416---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010417
10418Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10419they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10420possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10421passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10422the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010423the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10424match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010425
10426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104277.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10428-------------------------------------
10429
10430It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10431not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10432a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10433to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10434digits may be used upper or lower case.
10435
10436Example :
10437 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10438 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10439
10440
104417.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10442---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010443
10444IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10445netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10446within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010447host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010448difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10449at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10450does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10451parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010452
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010453IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10454Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10455trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10456IPv6 patterns.
10457
10458HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10459following situations :
10460 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10461 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10462 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10463 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10464 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10465 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10466 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10467 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10468 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10469 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010471
104727.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10473----------------------------------
10474
10475Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10476combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10477
10478 - AND (implicit)
10479 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10480 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010482A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010484 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010486Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10487indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010489For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10490"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10491requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10492is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10493
10494 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10495 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10496 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10497 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10498
10499To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10500and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10501
10502 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10503 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10504 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10505 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10506
10507 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10508 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10509 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10510 use_backend www if host_www
10511
10512It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10513expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10514be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10515the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10516
10517 The following rule :
10518
10519 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10520 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10521
10522 Can also be written that way :
10523
10524 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10525
10526It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10527to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10528simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10529sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10530good use is the following :
10531
10532 With named ACLs :
10533
10534 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10535 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10536 monitor fail if site_dead
10537
10538 With anonymous ACLs :
10539
10540 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10541
10542See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10543
10544
105457.3. Fetching samples
10546---------------------
10547
10548Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10549against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10550sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10551ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10552of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10553available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10554
10555This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10556Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10557compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10558deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10559
10560The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10561matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10562method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10563indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10564
10565As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10566when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10567mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10568the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10569ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10570
10571Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10572multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10573when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10574incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10575are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10576is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10577all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10578
10579Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10580 - name
10581 - name(arg1)
10582 - name(arg1,arg2)
10583
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010584
105857.3.1. Converters
10586-----------------
10587
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010588Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10589of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10590is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10591was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10592has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10593unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10594
10595These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10596sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10597the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10598support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010599
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010600A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10601support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10602supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
10603(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
10604bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
10605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010606The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010607
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010608add(<value>)
10609 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
10610 result as an unsigned integer.
10611
10612and(<value>)
10613 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10614 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10615
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010616base64
10617 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10618 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10619 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10620
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010621bool
10622 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10623 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10624 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10625 presence of a flag).
10626
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010627bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10628 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10629 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10630 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10631
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010632cpl
10633 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
10634 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10635
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010636crc32([<avalanche>])
10637 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
10638 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10639 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10640 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10641 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10642 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
10643 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
10644 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
10645 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
10646 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
10647 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
10648
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010649div(<value>)
10650 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10651 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
10652 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
10653
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010654djb2([<avalanche>])
10655 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10656 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10657 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10658 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10659 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10660 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10661 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010662 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
10663 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010664
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010665even
10666 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
10667 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
10668
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010669field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10670 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10671 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10672 list of chars.
10673
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010674hex
10675 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10676 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10677 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10678 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010679
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010680http_date([<offset>])
10681 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10682 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10683 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10684 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10685 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10686 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010687
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010688in_table(<table>)
10689 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10690 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10691 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10692 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10693 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10694
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010695ipmask(<mask>)
10696 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10697 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10698 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10699 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10700
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010701json([<input-code>])
10702 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10703 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10704 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10705 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10706 of errors:
10707 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10708 bytes, ...)
10709 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10710 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10711
10712 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10713 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10714 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10715 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10716 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10717 are :
10718 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10719 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10720 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10721 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10722 error ;
10723 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10724 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10725
10726 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10727 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10728
10729 Example:
10730 capture request header user-agent len 150
10731 capture request header Host len 15
10732 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10733
10734 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10735 GET / HTTP/1.0
10736 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10737
10738 Output log:
10739 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10740
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010741language(<value>[,<default>])
10742 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10743 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10744 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10745 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10746 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10747 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10748 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10749 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10750 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10751 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10752 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10753 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010754
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010755 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010756
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010757 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10758 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010759
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010760 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10761 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10762 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10763 use_backend spanish if es
10764 use_backend french if fr
10765 use_backend english if en
10766 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010767
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010768lower
10769 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10770 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10771 type. The result is of type string.
10772
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010773ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10774 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10775 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10776 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10777 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10778 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10779 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10780
10781 Example :
10782
10783 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10784 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10785 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10786
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010787map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10788map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10789map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10790 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10791 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10792 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10793 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10794 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10795 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10796 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10797 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010798
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010799 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10800 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10801 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010802
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010803 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10804 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010805
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010806 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10807 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10808 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10809 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010810 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10811 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010812 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10813 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10814 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10815 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10816 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10817 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10818 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10819 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10820 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10821 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10822 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10823 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10824 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10825 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010826
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010827 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10828 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10829 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10830 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10831 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010832
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010833 Example :
10834
10835 # this is a comment and is ignored
10836 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10837 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10838 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10839 | | | `---------- value
10840 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10841 | `---------------------------- key
10842 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10843
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010844mod(<value>)
10845 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10846 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
10847
10848mul(<value>)
10849 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
10850 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
10851 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
10852
10853neg
10854 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
10855 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
10856 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
10857 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10858
10859not
10860 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10861 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10862 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10863 absence of a flag).
10864
10865odd
10866 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
10867 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
10868
10869or(<value>)
10870 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10871 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10872
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010010873regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010010874 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
10875 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
10876 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
10877 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
10878 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
10879 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
10880 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
10881 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
10882 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
10883 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
10884 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
10885 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
10886 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
10887
10888 Example :
10889
10890 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
10891 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
10892 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
10893 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
10894
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010895sdbm([<avalanche>])
10896 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10897 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10898 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10899 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10900 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10901 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10902 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010903 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
10904 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010905
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010906sub(<value>)
10907 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
10908 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
10909 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10910
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010911table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10912 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10913 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10914 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10915 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10916 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10917 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10918
10919
10920table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10921 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10922 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10923 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10924 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10925 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10926 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10927
10928table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10929 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10930 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10931 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10932 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10933 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10934
10935table_conn_cur(<table>)
10936 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10937 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10938 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10939 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10940 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10941
10942table_conn_rate(<table>)
10943 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10944 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10945 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10946 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10947 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10948
10949table_gpc0(<table>)
10950 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10951 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10952 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10953 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10954 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10955
10956table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10957 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10958 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10959 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10960 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10961 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10962 sample fetch keyword.
10963
10964table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10965 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10966 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10967 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10968 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10969 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10970
10971table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10972 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10973 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10974 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10975 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10976 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10977 keyword.
10978
10979table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10980 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10981 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10982 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10983 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10984 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10985
10986table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10987 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10988 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10989 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10990 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10991 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10992 keyword.
10993
10994table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10995 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10996 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10997 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10998 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10999 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11000 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
11001 keyword.
11002
11003table_kbytes_out(<table>)
11004 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11005 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11006 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
11007 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11008 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11009 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
11010 keyword.
11011
11012table_server_id(<table>)
11013 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11014 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11015 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
11016 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
11017 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
11018 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
11019
11020table_sess_cnt(<table>)
11021 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11022 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11023 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11024 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
11025 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11026 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
11027 keyword.
11028
11029table_sess_rate(<table>)
11030 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11031 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11032 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
11033 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
11034 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11035 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
11036 keyword.
11037
11038table_trackers(<table>)
11039 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11040 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11041 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11042 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
11043 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
11044 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
11045 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
11046 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
11047 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
11048 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
11049
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011050upper
11051 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
11052 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11053 type. The result is of type string.
11054
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020011055url_dec
11056 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
11057 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
11058
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011059utime(<format>[,<offset>])
11060 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11061 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
11062 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11063 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11064 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11065 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
11066
11067 Example :
11068
11069 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
11070 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11071 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11072
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010011073word(<index>,<delimiters>)
11074 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
11075 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
11076
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011077wt6([<avalanche>])
11078 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
11079 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11080 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11081 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11082 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11083 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11084 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011085 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
11086 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011087
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011088xor(<value>)
11089 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
11090 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11091
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011092
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200110937.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011094--------------------------------------------
11095
11096A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
11097not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
11098"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
11099The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
11100
11101always_false : boolean
11102 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11103 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11104
11105always_true : boolean
11106 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11107 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11108
11109avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011110 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011111 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
11112 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
11113 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
11114 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
11115 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
11116 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
11117 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
11118 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
11119 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
11120 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
11121 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
11122 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
11123 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010011124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011125be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011126 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
11127 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
11128 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
11129 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
11130 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011132be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
11133 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11134 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11135 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
11136 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
11137 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
11138 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011139
11140 Example :
11141 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
11142 backend dynamic
11143 mode http
11144 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
11145 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011147connslots([<backend>]) : integer
11148 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011149 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011150 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
11151 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050011152
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011153 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011154 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011155 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
11156
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011157 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
11158 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011159
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011160 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011161 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011162 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011163 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
11164 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011165 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011166 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011167
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011168 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
11169 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011170 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011171 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011172
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011173date([<offset>]) : integer
11174 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
11175 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
11176 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
11177 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020011178 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
11179
11180 Example :
11181
11182 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
11183 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011184
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020011185env(<name>) : string
11186 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
11187 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
11188 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
11189 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
11190 certain way.
11191
11192 Examples :
11193 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
11194 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
11195
11196 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
11197 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
11198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011199fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
11200 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011201 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
11202 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011203 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
11204 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
11205 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
11206 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
11207 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011209fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
11210 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11211 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11212 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11213 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11214 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11215 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11216 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11217 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011218
11219 Example :
11220 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11221 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11222 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11223 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11224 frontend mail
11225 bind :25
11226 mode tcp
11227 maxconn 100
11228 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11229 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11230 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11231 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011232
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011233nbproc : integer
11234 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11235 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11236 and debugging purposes.
11237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011238nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11239 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11240 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11241 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011242 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11243 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11244 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011245
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011246proc : integer
11247 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11248 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11249 debugging purposes.
11250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011251queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011252 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11253 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11254 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011255 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11256 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11257 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11258 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11259 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11260
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011261rand([<range>]) : integer
11262 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11263 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11264 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11265 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11266 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011268srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11269 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11270 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11271 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11272 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11273 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11274 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11275 methods.
11276
11277srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11278 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11279 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11280 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11281 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11282 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11283 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11284 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11285
11286srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11287 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11288 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011289 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011290 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11291 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11292 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11293 overloading servers).
11294
11295 Example :
11296 # Redirect to a separate back
11297 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11298 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11299 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11300
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011301stopping : boolean
11302 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11303 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11304 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011306table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11307 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11308 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11309
11310table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11311 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11312 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11313 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11314
11315
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200113167.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011317----------------------------------
11318
11319The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11320closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11321methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11322sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11323TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011324the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11325counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11326"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011327argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11328the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11329this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011330
11331be_id : integer
11332 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11333 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11334
11335dst : ip
11336 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11337 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11338 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11339 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11340 RFC 4291.
11341
11342dst_conn : integer
11343 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11344 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11345 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11346 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11347 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11348 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11349 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11350 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011352dst_port : integer
11353 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11354 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11355 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11356 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11357 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11358 an HTTP header.
11359
11360fe_id : integer
11361 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11362 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11363 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11364
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011365sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011366sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11367sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11368sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011369 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11370 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11371 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11372
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011373sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011374sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11375sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11376sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011377 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11378 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11379 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11380
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011381sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011382sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11383sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11384sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011385 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11386 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011387 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11388 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11389 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011390
11391 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11392 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011393 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11394 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11395 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011396 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11397 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11398
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011399sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011400sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11401sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11402sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011403 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11404 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11405
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011406sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011407sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11408sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11409sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011410 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11411 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11412 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11413
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011414sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011415sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11416sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11417sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011418 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11419 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11420 See also src_conn_rate.
11421
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011422sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011423sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11424sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11425sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011426 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011427 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011428
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011429sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011430sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11431sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11432sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011433 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11434 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11435 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011436 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11437 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11438 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011439
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011440sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011441sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11442sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11443sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011444 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11445 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11446 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11447
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011448sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011449sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11450sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11451sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011452 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11453 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11454 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11455 src_http_err_rate.
11456
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011457sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011458sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11459sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11460sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011461 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11462 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11463 src_http_req_cnt.
11464
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011465sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011466sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11467sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11468sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011469 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11470 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11471 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11472 src_http_req_rate.
11473
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011474sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011475sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11476sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11477sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011478 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011479 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11480 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11481 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11482 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011483
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011484 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11485 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011486 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11487
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011488sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011489sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11490sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11491sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011492 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11493 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11494 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011495
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011496sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011497sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11498sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11499sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011500 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11501 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11502 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011503
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011504sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011505sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11506sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11507sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011508 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11509 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11510 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11511 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011512 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011513 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11514
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011515sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011516sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11517sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11518sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011519 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
11520 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11521 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
11522 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
11523 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011524 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011525
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011526sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011527sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11528sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11529sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020011530 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
11531 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
11532 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
11533
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011534sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011535sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11536sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11537sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011538 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11539 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011540 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011541 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
11542 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011543 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
11544 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
11545 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011547so_id : integer
11548 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
11549 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
11550 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011552src : ip
11553 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
11554 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
11555 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
11556 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
11557 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
11558 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
11559 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011560
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011561 Example:
11562 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
11563 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
11564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011565src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11566 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
11567 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
11568 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011569 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011571src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11572 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
11573 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011574 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011575 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011577src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11578 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11579 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11580 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
11581 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
11582 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
11583 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011584
11585 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11586 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
11587 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
11588 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011589 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011590 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11591 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011593src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011594 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011595 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011596 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011597 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011599src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011600 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011601 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
11602 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011603 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011605src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11606 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
11607 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11608 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011609 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011611src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011612 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011613 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011614 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011615 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011617src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011618 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011619 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011620 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
11621 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011622 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11623 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11624 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011626src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11627 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11628 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011629 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011630 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011631 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011633src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11634 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11635 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11636 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11637 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011638 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011640src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11641 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11642 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11643 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011644 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011646src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11647 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11648 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11649 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011650 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011651 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011653src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11654 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11655 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11656 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011657 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011658 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11659 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011660
11661 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011662 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011663 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011665src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011666 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11667 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11668 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11669 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11670 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011672src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011673 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11674 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11675 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11676 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11677 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011679src_port : integer
11680 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11681 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11682 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11683 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011685src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11686 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011687 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11688 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11689 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011690 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011692src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11693 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11694 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11695 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11696 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011697 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011699src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11700 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11701 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11702 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11703 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11704 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11705 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11706 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11707 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011708
11709 Example :
11710 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11711 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11712 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11713 listen ssh
11714 bind :22
11715 mode tcp
11716 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011717 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011718 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011719 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011721srv_id : integer
11722 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11723 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11724 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011725
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011726
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200117277.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011728----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011730The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11731closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11732when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11733usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011734future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011735
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011736ssl_bc : boolean
11737 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11738 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11739 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11740
11741ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11742 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11743 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11744
11745ssl_bc_cipher : string
11746 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11747 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11748
11749ssl_bc_protocol : string
11750 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11751 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11752
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011753ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011754 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011755 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11756 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011757
11758ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11759 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11760 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11761 if session was reused or not.
11762
11763ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11764 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11765 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011767ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11768 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11769 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11770 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11771 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11772 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011774ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11775 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11776 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11777 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11778 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011779
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011780ssl_c_der : binary
11781 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11782 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11783 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011785ssl_c_err : integer
11786 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11787 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11788 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11789 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11790 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011792ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11793 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11794 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11795 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11796 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11797 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11798 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11799 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11800 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011802ssl_c_key_alg : string
11803 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11804 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11805 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011807ssl_c_notafter : string
11808 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11809 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11810 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011812ssl_c_notbefore : string
11813 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11814 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11815 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011817ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11818 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11819 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11820 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11821 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11822 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11823 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11824 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11825 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011827ssl_c_serial : binary
11828 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11829 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11830 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011832ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11833 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11834 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11835 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011836 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11837 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11838
11839 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011841ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11842 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11843 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11844 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011846ssl_c_used : boolean
11847 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11848 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011850ssl_c_verify : integer
11851 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11852 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11853 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11854 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011856ssl_c_version : integer
11857 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11858 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011859
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011860ssl_f_der : binary
11861 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11862 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11863 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011865ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11866 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11867 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11868 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11869 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011870 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011871 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11872 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11873 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011875ssl_f_key_alg : string
11876 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11877 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11878 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011880ssl_f_notafter : string
11881 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11882 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11883 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011885ssl_f_notbefore : string
11886 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11887 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11888 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011890ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11891 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11892 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11893 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11894 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11895 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11896 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11897 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11898 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011900ssl_f_serial : binary
11901 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11902 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11903 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011904
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011905ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11906 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11907 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11908 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011910ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11911 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11912 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11913 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011915ssl_f_version : integer
11916 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11917 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11918
11919ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011920 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11921 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11922 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011924 Example :
11925 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11926 listen http-https
11927 bind :80
11928 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11929 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11930
11931ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11932 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11933 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11934
11935ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011936 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011937 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11938 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11939 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11940 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11941 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11942 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11943 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11944 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011946ssl_fc_cipher : string
11947 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11948 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011950ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011951 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11952 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011953 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11954 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11955 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11956 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011958ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11959 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011960 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11961 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11962 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11963 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011965ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011966 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011967 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11968 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11969 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11970 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11971 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11972 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11973 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011975ssl_fc_protocol : string
11976 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11977 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011978
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011979ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011980 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011981 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11982 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011984ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11985 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11986 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11987 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11988 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011990ssl_fc_sni : string
11991 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11992 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11993 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11994 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11995 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11996
11997 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11998 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11999 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020012000 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12001 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012003 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012004 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
12005 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020012006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012007ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
12008 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
12009 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012010
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012011
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200120127.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012013------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012015Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
12016sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
12017only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
12018For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
12019be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
12020can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
12021sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
12022for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
12023content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012025payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
12026 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
12027 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
12028 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012030payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
12031 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
12032 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
12033 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012035req.len : integer
12036req_len : integer (deprecated)
12037 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12038 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12039 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12040 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12041 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12042 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12043 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
12044 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012046req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12047 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012048 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12049 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12050 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12051 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012053 ACL alternatives :
12054 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012056req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12057 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12058 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12059 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
12060 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012062 ACL alternatives :
12063 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012065 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012067req.proto_http : boolean
12068req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
12069 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
12070 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
12071 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
12072 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
12073 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
12074 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
12075 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012077 Example:
12078 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12079 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12080 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012081 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012083req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
12084rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12085 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
12086 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
12087 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
12088 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
12089 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
12090 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
12091 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012093 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
12094 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
12095 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
12096 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
12097 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
12098 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012100 ACL derivatives :
12101 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012103 Example :
12104 listen tse-farm
12105 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
12106 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
12107 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12108 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
12109 # apply RDP cookie persistence
12110 persist rdp-cookie
12111 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
12112 # This is only useful makes sense if
12113 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
12114 stick-table type string size 204800
12115 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
12116 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
12117 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012119 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
12120 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012122req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
12123rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
12124 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
12125 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
12126 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
12127 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012129 ACL derivatives :
12130 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012132req.ssl_hello_type : integer
12133req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12134 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12135 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
12136 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12137 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12138 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
12139 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12140 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012142req.ssl_sni : string
12143req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
12144 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
12145 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
12146 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
12147 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12148 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12149 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
12150 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
12151 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
12152 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
12153 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
12154 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
12155 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012157 ACL derivatives :
12158 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012160 Examples :
12161 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
12162 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12163 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
12164 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
12165 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012167res.ssl_hello_type : integer
12168rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12169 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12170 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
12171 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12172 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12173 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
12174 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12175 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020012176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012177req.ssl_ver : integer
12178req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
12179 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
12180 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
12181 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
12182 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
12183 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12184 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12185 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
12186 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
12187 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012189 ACL derivatives :
12190 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012191
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020012192res.len : integer
12193 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12194 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12195 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12196 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12197 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12198 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12199 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
12200 content inspection.
12201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012202res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12203 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012204 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12205 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12206 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12207 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012209res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12210 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12211 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12212 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12213 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012215 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012217wait_end : boolean
12218 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12219 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12220 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12221 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12222 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12223 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12224 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12225 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012227 Examples :
12228 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12229 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12230 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012232 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12233 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12234 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12235 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12236 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12237 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12238 tcp-request content reject
12239
12240
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200122417.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012242--------------------------------------
12243
12244It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12245This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12246data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12247its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12248HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12249content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12250to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12251more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12252response are indexed.
12253
12254base : string
12255 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12256 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12257 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12258 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12259 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12260 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12261 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12262 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12263
12264 ACL derivatives :
12265 base : exact string match
12266 base_beg : prefix match
12267 base_dir : subdir match
12268 base_dom : domain match
12269 base_end : suffix match
12270 base_len : length match
12271 base_reg : regex match
12272 base_sub : substring match
12273
12274base32 : integer
12275 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12276 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12277 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012278 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12279 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12280 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012281
12282base32+src : binary
12283 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12284 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12285 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12286 per-URL counters.
12287
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012288capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12289 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12290 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12291 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12292
12293capture.req.method : string
12294 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12295 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12296 because it's allocated.
12297
12298capture.req.uri : string
12299 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12300 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12301 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12302 allocated.
12303
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012304capture.req.ver : string
12305 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12306 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12307 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12308
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012309capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12310 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12311 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12312 The first entry is an index of 0.
12313 See also: "capture response header"
12314
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012315capture.res.ver : string
12316 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12317 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12318 persistent flag.
12319
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012320req.body : binary
12321 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
12322 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12323 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
12324 the first chunk is analyzed.
12325
12326req.body_len : integer
12327 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
12328 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
12329 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12330 "option http-buffer-request".
12331
12332req.body_size : integer
12333 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
12334 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
12335 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
12336 that the request body has been buffered made available using
12337 "option http-buffer-request".
12338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012339req.cook([<name>]) : string
12340cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12341 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12342 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12343 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12344 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12345 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12346 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12347 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12348 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12349
12350 ACL derivatives :
12351 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12352 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12353 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12354 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12355 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12356 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12357 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12358 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012360req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12361cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12362 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12363 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012365req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12366cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12367 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12368 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12369 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12370 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012372cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12373 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12374 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12375 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12376 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12377 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12378 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12379 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12380 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12381 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12382 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012384hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12385 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12386 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12387 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12388 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012389 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012391req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12392 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12393 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12394 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12395 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12396 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12397 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12398 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12399 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012401req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12402 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12403 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12404 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12405 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012407req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12408 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12409 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12410 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12411 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12412 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12413 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12414 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12415 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12416 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12417 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12418 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012420 ACL derivatives :
12421 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12422 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12423 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12424 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12425 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12426 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12427 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12428 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12429
12430req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12431hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12432 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12433 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12434 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12435 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12436 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12437 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12438 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12439 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12440 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12441
12442req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12443hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12444 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12445 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12446 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12447 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12448 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12449 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12450 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12451 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12452
12453req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12454hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12455 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12456 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12457 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12458 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12459 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12460 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12461 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12462
12463http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12464 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12465 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12466 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12467 basic auth is supported.
12468
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012469http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12470 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12471 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12472 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12473 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012474 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12475 basic auth is supported.
12476
12477 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012478 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12479 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12480 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12481 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012482
12483http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012484 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12485 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012486 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12487 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012489method : integer + string
12490 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12491 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12492 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12493 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12494 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12495 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12496 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012498 ACL derivatives :
12499 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012501 Example :
12502 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
12503 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
12504 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012506path : string
12507 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
12508 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
12509 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
12510 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
12511 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
12512 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
12513 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012515 ACL derivatives :
12516 path : exact string match
12517 path_beg : prefix match
12518 path_dir : subdir match
12519 path_dom : domain match
12520 path_end : suffix match
12521 path_len : length match
12522 path_reg : regex match
12523 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012524
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010012525query : string
12526 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
12527 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
12528 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
12529 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
12530 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
12531 which stops before the question mark.
12532
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012533req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12534 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12535 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12536 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12537 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012539req.ver : string
12540req_ver : string (deprecated)
12541 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
12542 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
12543 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012545 ACL derivatives :
12546 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012548res.comp : boolean
12549 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
12550 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
12551 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012553res.comp_algo : string
12554 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
12555 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
12556 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012558res.cook([<name>]) : string
12559scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12560 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12561 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12562 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012564 ACL derivatives :
12565 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012567res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12568scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12569 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12570 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
12571 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012573res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12574scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12575 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12576 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
12577 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012579res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12580 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12581 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12582 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12583 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12584 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
12585 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
12586 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
12587 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
12588 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012590res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12591 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12592 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12593 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12594 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
12595 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012597res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12598shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
12599 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12600 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12601 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12602 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12603 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
12604 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
12605 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
12606 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012608 ACL derivatives :
12609 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12610 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12611 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12612 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12613 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12614 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12615 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12616 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12617
12618res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12619shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12620 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12621 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12622 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
12623 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
12624 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012626res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12627shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12628 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
12629 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
12630 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
12631 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
12632 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
12633 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012634
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012635res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12636 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12637 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12638 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12639 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012641res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12642shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12643 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
12644 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12645 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12646 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12647 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
12648 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012650res.ver : string
12651resp_ver : string (deprecated)
12652 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
12653 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012655 ACL derivatives :
12656 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012658set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12659 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12660 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12661 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12662 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012664 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12665 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012667 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012669status : integer
12670 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12671 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12672 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012674url : string
12675 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12676 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12677 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12678 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12679 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12680 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12681 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012683 ACL derivatives :
12684 url : exact string match
12685 url_beg : prefix match
12686 url_dir : subdir match
12687 url_dom : domain match
12688 url_end : suffix match
12689 url_len : length match
12690 url_reg : regex match
12691 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012693url_ip : ip
12694 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
12695 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
12696 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
12697 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
12698 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
12699 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12700 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012702url_port : integer
12703 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
12704 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
12705 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12706 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012708urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12709url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12710 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
12711 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
12712 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
12713 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
12714 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
12715 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12716 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
12717 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
12718 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012720 ACL derivatives :
12721 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12722 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12723 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12724 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12725 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12726 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12727 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12728 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012729
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012731 Example :
12732 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12733 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12734 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12735 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012737urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
12738 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12739 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12740 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012741
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127437.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012744---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012746Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12747every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012748order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012750ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12751---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012752FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012753HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012754HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12755HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012756HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12757HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12758HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12759HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12760LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012761METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12762METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12763METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12764METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12765METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12766METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012767RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012768REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012769TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012770WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12771---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012772
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127748. Logging
12775----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012776
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012777One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12778provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12779very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12780provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12781state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012782to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012783headers.
12784
12785In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12786about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12787send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12788
12789 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12790 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12791 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12792 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12793 at the termination.
12794
12795The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12796allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12797as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12798while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12799real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12800delay.
12801
12802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128038.1. Log levels
12804---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012805
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012806TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012807source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012808HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12809in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12810track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12811syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12812about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012813
12814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128158.2. Log formats
12816----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012817
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012818HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012819and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12820slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12821options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012822
12823 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12824 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12825 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12826 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12827 extents.
12828
12829 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12830 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12831 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12832 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12833 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12834
12835 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12836 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12837 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12838 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12839 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12840
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012841 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12842 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12843 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12844 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12845
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012846 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12847
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012848Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12849specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12850field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12851servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12852always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12853identifier.
12854
12855Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12856 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12857 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12858 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12859 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12860
12861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128628.2.1. Default log format
12863-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012864
12865This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12866as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12867format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12868
12869 Example :
12870 listen www
12871 mode http
12872 log global
12873 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12874
12875 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12876 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12877 (www/HTTP)
12878
12879 Field Format Extract from the example above
12880 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12881 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12882 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12883 4 'to' to
12884 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12885 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12886
12887Detailed fields description :
12888 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12889 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12890 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12891 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12892 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12893 and processed the connection.
12894 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12895
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012896In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12897"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12898connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12899
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012900It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12901will eventually disappear.
12902
12903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129048.2.2. TCP log format
12905---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012906
12907The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12908is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12909information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12910counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12911emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12912environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12913the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12914sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012915specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12916not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12917fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12918marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012919
12920 Example :
12921 frontend fnt
12922 mode tcp
12923 option tcplog
12924 log global
12925 default_backend bck
12926
12927 backend bck
12928 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12929
12930 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12931 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12932 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12933
12934 Field Format Extract from the example above
12935 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12936 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12937 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12938 4 frontend_name fnt
12939 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12940 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12941 7 bytes_read* 212
12942 8 termination_state --
12943 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12944 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12945
12946Detailed fields description :
12947 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012948 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12949 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12950 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12951 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12952 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012953
12954 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012955 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12956 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12957 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012958
12959 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12960 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12961 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12962 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12963
12964 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12965 and processed the connection.
12966
12967 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12968 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12969 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12970 applications.
12971
12972 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12973 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12974 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12975 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12976 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12977
12978 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12979 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12980 See "Timers" below for more details.
12981
12982 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12983 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12984 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12985 "Timers" below for more details.
12986
12987 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012988 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012989 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12990 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12991 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12992 details.
12993
12994 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12995 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12996 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12997 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12998 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12999
13000 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13001 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13002 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
13003 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
13004 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
13005 for more details.
13006
13007 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013008 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013009 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
13010 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
13011 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013012 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013013
13014 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13015 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13016 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13017 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13018 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13019 caused by a denial of service attack.
13020
13021 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13022 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13023 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13024 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13025 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13026 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13027 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13028 denial of service attack.
13029
13030 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13031 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13032 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13033 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13034 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13035 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13036 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13037 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
13038 be processed than on other servers.
13039
13040 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13041 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13042 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13043 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13044 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13045 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13046 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13047 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13048 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13049 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13050 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13051 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13052 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13053
13054 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13055 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13056 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13057 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13058 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13059 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13060 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13061 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13062
13063 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13064 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13065 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13066 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13067 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13068 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13069 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13070 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13071 occurs.
13072
13073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130748.2.3. HTTP log format
13075----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013076
13077The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
13078is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
13079the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
13080are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
13081emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
13082generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
13083"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
13084which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013085frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
13086is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013087
13088Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
13089slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
13090with a star ('*') after the field name below.
13091
13092 Example :
13093 frontend http-in
13094 mode http
13095 option httplog
13096 log global
13097 default_backend bck
13098
13099 backend static
13100 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13101
13102 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
13103 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
13104 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013105 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013106
13107 Field Format Extract from the example above
13108 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
13109 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
13110 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
13111 4 frontend_name http-in
13112 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
13113 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
13114 7 status_code 200
13115 8 bytes_read* 2750
13116 9 captured_request_cookie -
13117 10 captured_response_cookie -
13118 11 termination_state ----
13119 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
13120 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13121 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
13122 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
13123 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013124
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013125
13126Detailed fields description :
13127 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013128 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13129 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13130 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13131 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13132 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013133
13134 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013135 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13136 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13137 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013138
13139 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
13140 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
13141 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
13142 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
13143 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
13144
13145 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13146 and processed the connection.
13147
13148 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13149 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13150 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
13151
13152 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13153 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13154 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13155 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
13156 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
13157 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
13158
13159 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
13160 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
13161 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
13162 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
13163 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
13164 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
13165
13166 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13167 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13168 See "Timers" below for more details.
13169
13170 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13171 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13172 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
13173 below for more details.
13174
13175 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
13176 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
13177 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
13178 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
13179 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
13180 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
13181 for more details.
13182
13183 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013184 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013185 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13186 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13187 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13188 details.
13189
13190 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
13191 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
13192 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
13193
13194 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
13195 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
13196 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
13197 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
13198 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
13199 overflowing.
13200
13201 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
13202 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
13203 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
13204 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
13205 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
13206 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
13207 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
13208 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13209
13210 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
13211 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
13212 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
13213 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
13214 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
13215 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
13216 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
13217 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13218
13219 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13220 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13221 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
13222 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
13223 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
13224 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
13225 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
13226
13227 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013228 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013229 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13230 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13231 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013232 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013233 system.
13234
13235 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13236 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13237 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13238 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13239 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13240 caused by a denial of service attack.
13241
13242 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13243 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13244 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13245 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13246 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13247 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13248 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13249 denial of service attack.
13250
13251 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13252 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13253 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13254 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13255 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13256 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13257 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13258 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13259 processed than on other servers.
13260
13261 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13262 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13263 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13264 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13265 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13266 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13267 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13268 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13269 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13270 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13271 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13272 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13273 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13274
13275 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13276 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13277 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13278 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13279 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13280 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13281 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13282 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13283
13284 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13285 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13286 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13287 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13288 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13289 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13290 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13291 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13292 occurs.
13293
13294 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13295 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13296 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13297 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13298 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13299 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13300 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13301 cookies" below for more details.
13302
13303 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13304 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13305 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13306 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13307 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13308 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13309 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13310 and cookies" below for more details.
13311
13312 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13313 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13314 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13315 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13316 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13317 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13318 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13319 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13320
13321
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200133228.2.4. Custom log format
13323------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013324
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013325The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013326mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013327
13328HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13329Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13330separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13331prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13332
13333Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13334variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13335string formats ("Q").
13336
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013337If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013338as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013339less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13340the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13341
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013342Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013343In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013344in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013345
13346Flags are :
13347 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013348 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013349
13350 Example:
13351
13352 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13353 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13354
13355At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13356
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013357 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13358 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013359
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013360the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013361
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013362 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013363 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013364 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013365
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013366and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13367
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013368 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013369 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13370
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013371Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13372
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013373 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013374 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013375 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13376 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13377 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013378 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13379 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13380 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013381 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000013382 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
13383 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
13384 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
13385 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013386 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013387 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013388 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013389 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013390 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013391 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13392 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013393 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013394 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13395 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013396 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013397 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13398 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013399 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13400 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13401 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013402 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013403 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13404 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013405 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013406 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13407 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13408 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013409 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013410 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013411 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13412 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13413 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13414 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013415 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013416 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013417 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013418 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013419 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013420 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013421 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13422 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13423 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013424 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013425 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13426 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013427 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013428 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013429 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013430 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013431
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013432 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013433
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013434
134358.2.5. Error log format
13436-----------------------
13437
13438When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13439protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13440By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13441"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13442will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13443logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13444
13445The format looks like this :
13446
13447 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13448 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13449 Connection error during SSL handshake
13450
13451 Field Format Extract from the example above
13452 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13453 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13454 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13455 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13456 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13457
13458These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13459failures.
13460
13461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134628.3. Advanced logging options
13463-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013464
13465Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13466just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13467options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13468for more information about their usage.
13469
13470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134718.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13472------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013473
13474It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13475haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13476commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13477monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13478ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13479
13480 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13481 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13482 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13483 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13484
13485 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13486 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13487 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013488 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013489 such as other load-balancers.
13490
13491 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13492 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13493 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13494
13495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13497----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013498
13499The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
13500what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
13501or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
13502"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
13503just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
13504log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
13505after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
13506is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
13507with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
13508with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
13509
13510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135118.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
13512------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013513
13514Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
13515for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
13516"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
13517retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
13518raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
13519a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
13520file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
13521you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
13522"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
13523
13524
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135258.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
13526--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013527
13528Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
13529multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
13530them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
13531"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
13532logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
13533error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
13534and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
13535too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
13536useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
13537alternative.
13538
13539
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135408.4. Timing events
13541------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013542
13543Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
13544reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
13545the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
13546frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
13547mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
13548
13549 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
13550 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
13551 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
13552 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
13553 the client closes prematurely or times out.
13554
13555 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
13556 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
13557 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
13558 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
13559 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
13560
13561 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
13562 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
13563 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
13564 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
13565 connection never established.
13566
13567 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
13568 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
13569 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
13570 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
13571 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
13572 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
13573 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
13574 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
13575 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
13576 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
13577 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
13578
13579 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
13580 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
13581 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
13582 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013583 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013584
13585 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
13586
13587 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
13588 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
13589 negative.
13590
13591These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
13592protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
13593that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013594due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013595close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
13596session has been aborted on timeout.
13597
13598Most common cases :
13599
13600 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13601 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
13602 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
13603 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
13604 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
13605 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
13606 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
13607 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
13608 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020013609 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
13610 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
13611 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013612
13613 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13614 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
13615 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
13616 of ms on remote networks.
13617
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013618 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
13619 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
13620 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013621
13622 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
13623 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
13624 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
13625 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
13626 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
13627 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
13628 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
13629 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
13630 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
13631 to the server until another one is released.
13632
13633Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
13634
13635 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
13636 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
13637 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
13638
13639 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
13640 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
13641 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
13642
13643 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
13644 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
13645 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
13646 flags.
13647
13648 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
13649 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
13650 Check the session termination flags, then check the
13651 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
13652 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
13653 the client connection was maintained open.
13654
13655 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013656 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013657 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
13658 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
13659
13660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136618.5. Session state at disconnection
13662-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013663
13664TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13665"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
136662-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13667each of which has a special meaning :
13668
13669 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13670 session to terminate :
13671
13672 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13673
13674 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13675 server explicitly refused it.
13676
13677 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13678 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13679 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13680 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013681 (eg: cacheable cookie).
13682
13683 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
13684 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013685
13686 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
13687 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
13688 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
13689 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
13690 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
13691
13692 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
13693 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
13694 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
13695 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
13696 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
13697
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090013698 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
13699 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
13700
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013701 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
13702 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
13703 backup connections when going up.
13704
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020013705 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
13706
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013707 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
13708 send or receive data.
13709
13710 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
13711 send or receive data.
13712
13713 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
13714 with nothing left in the buffers.
13715
13716 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13717
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013718 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013719 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13720
13721 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13722 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13723 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13724 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13725 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13726
13727 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13728 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13729
13730 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13731 server (HTTP only).
13732
13733 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13734
13735 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13736 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13737 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13738
13739 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13740 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13741 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13742
13743 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13744
13745 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13746 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13747
13748 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13749 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13750 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13751
13752 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13753 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013754 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13755 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013756
13757 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13758 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13759 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13760 another server.
13761
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013762 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013763 server.
13764
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013765 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13766 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13767 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13768 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13769
13770 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13771 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13772 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13773 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13774
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013775 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13776 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13777 "use-server" rule).
13778
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013779 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13780
13781 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13782 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13783
13784 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13785
13786 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13787 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13788 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13789
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013790 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13791 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013792 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013793 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13794 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13795
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013796 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13797
13798 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13799 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13800
13801 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13802
13803 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13804
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013805The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13806was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013807helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13808starvation, attacks, etc...
13809
13810The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13811alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13812easier finding and understanding.
13813
13814 Flags Reason
13815
13816 -- Normal termination.
13817
13818 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13819 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13820 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13821 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13822
13823 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13824 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13825 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13826 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13827 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13828 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013829
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013830 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13831 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013832 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013833
13834 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13835 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13836 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13837
13838 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13839 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13840 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13841 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13842 the server takes too long to respond.
13843
13844 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13845 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13846 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13847 long a time to respond.
13848
13849 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13850 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13851 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13852 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013853 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
13854 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013855
13856 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13857 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13858 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13859 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13860 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013861 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013862 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
13863 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
13864 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
13865 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
13866 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
13867 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
13868 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
13869 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
13870 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
13871 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
13872 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
13873 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013874
13875 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13876 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013877 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13878 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13879 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13880 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013881
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013882 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13883 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13884
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013885 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013886 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13887 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13888 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13889 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13890 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13891
13892 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13893 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13894 503 or 504 here.
13895
13896 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13897 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13898 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13899 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13900 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13901
13902 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13903 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013904 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013905 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13906 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13907
13908 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13909 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13910 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13911 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13912 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13913 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13914 between haproxy and the server.
13915
13916 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13917 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13918 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13919 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13920 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13921 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13922 solution is to fix the application.
13923
13924 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13925 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13926 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13927 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13928 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13929 external attacks.
13930
13931 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13932 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013933 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013934 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13935 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13936
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013937 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13938 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13939 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013940 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13941 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013942
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013943 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13944 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13945 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13946 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013947 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13948 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13949 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13950 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13951 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013952
13953 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13954 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13955 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13956 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13957
13958 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13959 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13960 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13961 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13962
13963 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13964 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13965 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13966 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13967
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013968The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13969persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13970important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13971re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13972
13973 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13974
13975 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13976 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13977 set on a GET request.
13978
13979 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13980 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013981 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013982 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13983
13984 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13985 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13986 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13987
13988 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13989 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13990 already got a cookie.
13991
13992 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13993 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13994 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13995 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13996 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13997
13998 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13999 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14000 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14001
14002 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
14003 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14004 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14005
14006 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
14007 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
14008
14009 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
14010 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
14011 then advertised in the response.
14012
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140148.6. Non-printable characters
14015-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014016
14017In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
14018consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
14019converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
14020prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
14021being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
14022escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
14023is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
14024'}' when logging headers.
14025
14026Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
14027issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
14028containing spaces is "User-Agent".
14029
14030Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
14031the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
14032performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
14033
14034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140358.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
14036---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014037
14038Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
14039achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014040section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014041cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
14042the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
14043the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014044locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014045not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
14046user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
14047a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
14048wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
14049
14050 Examples :
14051 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
14052 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
14053
14054 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
14055 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
14056
14057
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140588.8. Capturing HTTP headers
14059---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014060
14061Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
14062proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
14063the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
14064server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
14065
14066Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
14067response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014068section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014069
14070It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014071time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
14072appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014073are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
14074and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
14075follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
14076request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
14077in the logs.
14078
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014079As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
14080frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
14081an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
14082
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014083 Example :
14084 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
14085 listen proxy-out
14086 mode http
14087 option httplog
14088 option logasap
14089 log global
14090 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
14091
14092 # log the name of the virtual server
14093 capture request header Host len 20
14094
14095 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
14096 capture request header Content-Length len 10
14097
14098 # log the beginning of the referrer
14099 capture request header Referer len 20
14100
14101 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
14102 capture response header Server len 20
14103
14104 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
14105 capture response header Content-Length len 10
14106
14107 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
14108 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
14109
14110 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
14111 capture response header Via len 20
14112
14113 # log the URL location during a redirection
14114 capture response header Location len 20
14115
14116 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
14117 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
14118 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14119 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
14120 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
14121
14122 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14123 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14124 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14125 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014126 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014127
14128 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14129 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14130 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14131 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
14132 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014133 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014134
14135
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141368.9. Examples of logs
14137---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014138
14139These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
14140them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
14141reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
14142
14143 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
14144 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14145 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14146
14147 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
14148 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
14149
14150 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
14151 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
14152 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14153
14154 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
14155 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
14156
14157 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
14158 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14159 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
14160
14161 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014162 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014163 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
14164 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
14165
14166 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
14167 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
14168 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
14169
14170 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
14171 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020014172 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014173 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
14174 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
14175 to return the 502 and not the server.
14176
14177 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014178 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014179
14180 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
14181 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
14182 Nothing was sent to any server.
14183
14184 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
14185 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
14186
14187 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
14188 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
14189 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
14190 send a 408 return code to the client.
14191
14192 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
14193 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
14194
14195 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
14196 5 seconds ("c----").
14197
14198 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
14199 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014200 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014201
14202 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014203 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014204 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
14205 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
14206 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
14207 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
14208 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014209
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142119. Statistics and monitoring
14212----------------------------
14213
14214It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
14215mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
14216CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
14217Unix socket.
14218
14219
142209.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014221---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010014222
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014223The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020014224page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
14225begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
14226represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
14227use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
14228('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
14229(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
14230text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
14231do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
14232use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014233
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014234In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14235that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14236S (Servers).
14237
14238 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14239 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14240 any name for server/listener)
14241 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14242 number queued without a server assigned.
14243 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14244 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14245 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14246 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14247 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14248 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14249 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14250 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14251 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14252 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14253 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14254 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14255 "option checkcache".
14256 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14257 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14258 - read error from the client
14259 - client timeout
14260 - client closed connection
14261 - various bad requests from the client.
14262 - request was tarpitted.
14263 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14264 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14265 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14266 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14267 active servers).
14268 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14269 Some other errors are:
14270 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14271 - failure applying filters to the response.
14272 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14273 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14274 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14275 switched away from.
14276 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
14277 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
14278 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
14279 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
14280 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14281 the server is up.)
14282 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14283 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14284 counters for each server.
14285 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14286 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14287 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14288 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14289 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14290 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14291 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14292 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14293 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14294 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14295 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14296 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14297 of times that server was selected.
14298 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14299 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14300 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14301 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14302 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14303 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014304 UNK -> unknown
14305 INI -> initializing
14306 SOCKERR -> socket error
14307 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080014308 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014309 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14310 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14311 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14312 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14313 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14314 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14315 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14316 disable-on-404
14317 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14318 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14319 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014320 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14321 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14322 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14323 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14324 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14325 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14326 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14327 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14328 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14329 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14330 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14331 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14332 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14333 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14334 (inc. in eresp)
14335 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14336 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14337 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14338 (CPU/BW limit)
14339 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14340 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14341 server/backend
14342 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14343 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14344 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14345 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14346 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14347 (0 for TCP)
14348 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14349 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014350
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143529.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014353-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014354
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014355The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14356necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14357A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14358issuing commands by hand :
14359
14360 global
14361 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14362 stats timeout 2m
14363
14364It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14365the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14366never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14367situations :
14368
14369 global
14370 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14371 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14372 stats timeout 2m
14373
14374To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14375swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14376to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14377syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14378
14379 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14380 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14381
14382The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14383script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14384for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14385
14386The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14387that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14388editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14389(eg: watch a counter).
14390
14391The socket supports two operation modes :
14392 - interactive
14393 - non-interactive
14394
14395The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14396this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14397sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14398mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14399commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14400example :
14401
14402 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14403
14404The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14405entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14406for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14407sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14408"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14409after processing the last command of the same line.
14410
14411For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14412"prompt" command :
14413
14414 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14415 prompt
14416 > show info
14417 ...
14418 >
14419
14420Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14421delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14422that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14423parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014424
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014425It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14426on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14427own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014428
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014429The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14430If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14431all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14432it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14433
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014434add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014435 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14436 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14437 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14438 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014439
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014440add map <map> <key> <value>
14441 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14442 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014443 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14444 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14445 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014446
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014447clear counters
14448 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14449 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14450 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14451 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14452 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14453
14454clear counters all
14455 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14456 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14457 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14458
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014459clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014460 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14461 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14462 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014463
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014464clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014465 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14466 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14467 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014468
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014469clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14470 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14471
14472 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14473 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14474 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14475 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14476 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14477 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14478
14479 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14480
14481 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14482 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14483 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14484 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14485 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14486 the ACLs :
14487
14488 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14489 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14490 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14491 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14492 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14493 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14494
14495 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014496 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14497 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014498
14499 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014500 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014501 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014502 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14503 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14504 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14505 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014506
14507 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14508
14509 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014510 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014511 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14512 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014513 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14514 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14515 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014516
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014517del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
14518 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014519 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
14520 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14521 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
14522 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014523
14524del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014525 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014526 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
14527 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14528 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
14529 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014530
14531disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014532 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
14533
14534 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
14535 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
14536 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
14537 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
14538 re-enabled using enable agent.
14539
14540 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
14541 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
14542 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
14543 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
14544 otherwise unchanged.
14545
14546 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
14547 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
14548 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
14549
14550 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14551 level "admin".
14552
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014553disable frontend <frontend>
14554 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
14555 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
14556 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
14557 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
14558 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
14559 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
14560 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
14561 on the stats page.
14562
14563 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14564 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14565
14566 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14567 level "admin".
14568
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014569disable health <backend>/<server>
14570 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
14571 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
14572 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
14573 agent check forces it down.
14574
14575 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14576 level "admin".
14577
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014578disable server <backend>/<server>
14579 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
14580 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
14581 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
14582 during the maintenance.
14583
14584 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
14585 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
14586
14587 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014588 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014589
14590 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14591 level "admin".
14592
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014593enable agent <backend>/<server>
14594 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
14595
14596 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
14597 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
14598
14599 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14600 level "admin".
14601
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014602enable frontend <frontend>
14603 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
14604 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
14605 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
14606 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
14607 which was disabled.
14608
14609 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14610 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14611
14612 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14613 level "admin".
14614
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014615enable health <backend>/<server>
14616 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
14617 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
14618
14619 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14620 level "admin".
14621
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014622enable server <backend>/<server>
14623 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
14624 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
14625
14626 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014627 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014628
14629 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14630 level "admin".
14631
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014632get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014633get acl <acl> <value>
14634 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
14635 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
14636 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
14637 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
14638 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014639
14640 The first two words are:
14641
14642 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
14643 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
14644 "dom", "end" or "reg".
14645
14646 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
14647
14648 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
14649
14650 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
14651
14652 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
14653 interpretation of the case.
14654
14655 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
14656 useful with regular expressions.
14657
14658 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
14659 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
14660
14661 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
14662 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
14663 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
14664
14665 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14666
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014667get weight <backend>/<server>
14668 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14669 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14670 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14671 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14672 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014673 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014674
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014675help
14676 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14677 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014678
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014679prompt
14680 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
14681 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
14682 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
14683 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
14684 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
14685 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
14686 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
14687 command.
14688
14689quit
14690 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014691
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014692set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014693 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
14694 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
14695 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014696
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014697set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020014698 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
14699 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
14700 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
14701 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
14702 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014703 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
14704 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14705
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020014706set maxconn global <maxconn>
14707 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
14708 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
14709 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
14710 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
14711 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
14712 setting.
14713
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020014714set rate-limit connections global <value>
14715 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14716 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14717 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14718 is passed in number of connections per second.
14719
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014720set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14721 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14722 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014723 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14724 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014725
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014726set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14727 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14728 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14729 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14730 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14731
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014732set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14733 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14734 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14735 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14736 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14737 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14738
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014739set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14740 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14741 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14742 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14743
14744set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14745 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14746 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14747 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14748
14749set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14750 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14751 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14752 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14753 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14754 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14755 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14756 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14757 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14758
14759set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14760 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14761 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14762
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014763set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14764 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14765 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14766 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14767 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14768
14769 Example:
14770 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14771 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14772 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14773 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14774
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020014775set ssl tls-key <id> <tlskey>
14776 Set the next TLS key for the <id> listener to <tlskey>. This key becomes the
14777 ultimate key, while the penultimate one is used for encryption (others just
14778 decrypt). The oldest TLS key present is overwritten. <id> is either a numeric
14779 #<id> or <file> returned by "show tls-keys". <tlskey> is a base64 encoded 48
14780 bit TLS ticket key (ex. openssl rand -base64 48).
14781
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014782set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014783 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14784 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14785 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14786 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014787 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14788 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014789
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014790set timeout cli <delay>
14791 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14792 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14793 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14794
14795set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14796 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14797 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014798 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14799 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14800 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14801 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14802 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14803 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14804 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14805 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14806 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14807 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14808 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14809 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14810 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014811
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014812show errors [<iid>]
14813 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14814 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014815 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14816 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14817 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014818
14819 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14820 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14821 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14822 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14823 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14824 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14825 are reported too.
14826
14827 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14828 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14829 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14830 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14831 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14832 code.
14833
14834 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14835 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14836 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14837 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14838 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14839 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14840 line.
14841
14842 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014843 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14844 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014845 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14846 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14847
14848 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14849 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14850 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14851 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14852 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14853 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14854 00204+ minal\r\n
14855 00211 \r\n
14856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014857 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014858 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14859 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14860 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14861 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14862 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14863 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014864
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014865show info
14866 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14867
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014868show map [<map>]
14869 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014870 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14871 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14872 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14873 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14874 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14875 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014876
14877show acl [<acl>]
14878 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014879 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14880 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14881 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14882 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14883 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014884
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014885show pools
14886 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14887 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14888 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14889 the pools.
14890
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014891show sess
14892 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014893 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14894 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14895
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014896show sess <id>
14897 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14898 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14899 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14900 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14901 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014902 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14903 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14904
14905 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14906 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014907
14908show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14909 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14910 possible to dump only selected items :
14911 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14912 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14913 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14914 for example:
14915 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14916 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14917 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14918
14919 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014920 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14921 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014922 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14923 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14924 Nbproc: 1
14925 Process_num: 1
14926 (...)
14927
14928 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14929 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14930 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14931 (...)
14932 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14933
14934 $
14935
14936 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14937 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14938 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14939 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014940 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014941
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014942show table
14943 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14944 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14945 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14946 entries currently in use.
14947
14948 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014949 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014950 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14951 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014952
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014953show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014954 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14955 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14956 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014957 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14958
14959 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14960 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14961 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14962 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14963 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14964
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014965 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14966 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14967 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14968 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14969 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14970 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14971
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014972
14973 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014974 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14975 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014976
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014977 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014978 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014979 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014980 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14981 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14982 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14983 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014984
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014985 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014986 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014987 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14988 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014989
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014990 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14991 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014992 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014993 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14994 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014995
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014996 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14997 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014998 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014999 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15000 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
15001
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015002 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
15003 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
15004 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
15005 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
15006 time goes, the average event rate drops.
15007
15008 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
15009 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
15010 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015011 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
15012 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015013 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
15014 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020015015
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015016show tls-keys
15017 Dump all loaded TLS ticket keys. The TLS ticket key reference ID and the
15018 file from which the keys have been loaded is shown. Both of those can be
15019 used to update the TLS keys using "set ssl tls-key".
15020
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015021shutdown frontend <frontend>
15022 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
15023 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
15024 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
15025 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
15026 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
15027 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
15028 once it is terminated.
15029
15030 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15031 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15032
15033 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15034 level "admin".
15035
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020015036shutdown session <id>
15037 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
15038 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15039 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
15040 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
15041 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
15042 flag in the logs.
15043
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020015044shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015045 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
15046 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
15047 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
15048 'K' flag in the logs.
15049
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015050/*
15051 * Local variables:
15052 * fill-column: 79
15053 * End:
15054 */